1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 /*
3 * mac80211 <-> driver interface
4 *
5 * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc.
6 * Copyright 2006-2007 Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz>
7 * Copyright 2007-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8 * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9 * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
10 * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2025 Intel Corporation
11 */
12
13 #ifndef MAC80211_H
14 #define MAC80211_H
15
16 #include <linux/bug.h>
17 #include <linux/kernel.h>
18 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
19 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
20 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
21 #include <linux/lockdep.h>
22 #include <linux/android_kabi.h>
23 #include <net/cfg80211.h>
24 #include <net/codel.h>
25 #include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h>
26 #include <linux/unaligned.h>
27
28 /**
29 * DOC: Introduction
30 *
31 * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements
32 * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document
33 * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware
34 * drivers.
35 */
36
37 /**
38 * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts
39 *
40 * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be
41 * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any
42 * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such
43 * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the
44 * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even
45 * tasklet function.
46 *
47 * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also
48 * use the non-IRQ-safe functions!
49 */
50
51 /**
52 * DOC: Warning
53 *
54 * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will
55 * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet.
56 */
57
58 /**
59 * DOC: Frame format
60 *
61 * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver,
62 * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are
63 * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the
64 * hardware.
65 *
66 * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features:
67 *
68 * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload
69 * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware.
70 *
71 * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to
72 * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU.
73 */
74
75 /**
76 * DOC: mac80211 workqueue
77 *
78 * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use.
79 * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by
80 * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the
81 * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback.
82 *
83 * mac80211 will flush the workqueue upon interface removal and during
84 * suspend.
85 *
86 * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock.
87 *
88 */
89
90 /**
91 * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing
92 *
93 * mac80211 uses an intermediate queueing implementation, designed to allow the
94 * driver to keep hardware queues short and to provide some fairness between
95 * different stations/interfaces.
96 *
97 * Drivers must provide the .wake_tx_queue driver operation by either
98 * linking it to ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() or implementing a custom
99 * handler.
100 *
101 * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with
102 * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and
103 * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames.
104 *
105 * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations
106 * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops.
107 *
108 * The driver can't access the internal TX queues (iTXQs) directly.
109 * Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue
110 * driver op.
111 * Drivers implementing a custom .wake_tx_queue op can get them by calling
112 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Drivers using ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() will
113 * simply get the individual frames pushed via the .tx driver operation.
114 *
115 * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to
116 * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to
117 * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls
118 * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using
119 * ieee80211_return_txq().
120 *
121 * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has
122 * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling
123 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq
124 * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls
125 * .release_buffered_frames().
126 * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own
127 * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained
128 * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue).
129 */
130
131 /**
132 * DOC: HW timestamping
133 *
134 * Timing Measurement and Fine Timing Measurement require accurate timestamps
135 * of the action frames TX/RX and their respective acks.
136 *
137 * To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine Timing
138 * Measurement frame RX, the low level driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp
139 * field to the frame RX timestamp and report the ack TX timestamp in the
140 * ieee80211_rx_status struct.
141 *
142 * Similarly, to report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine
143 * Timing Measurement frame TX, the driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp field
144 * to the frame TX timestamp and report the ack RX timestamp in the
145 * ieee80211_tx_status struct.
146 */
147 struct device;
148
149 /**
150 * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues
151 *
152 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues.
153 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set
154 */
155 enum ieee80211_max_queues {
156 IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES = 16,
157 IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP = BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1,
158 };
159
160 #define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE 0xff
161
162 /**
163 * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211
164 * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice
165 * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video
166 * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort
167 * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background
168 */
169 enum ieee80211_ac_numbers {
170 IEEE80211_AC_VO = 0,
171 IEEE80211_AC_VI = 1,
172 IEEE80211_AC_BE = 2,
173 IEEE80211_AC_BK = 3,
174 };
175
176 /**
177 * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration
178 *
179 * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS
180 * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29.
181 *
182 * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255]
183 * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form
184 * 2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
185 * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min]
186 * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
187 * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category
188 * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue
189 * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured
190 * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE
191 */
192 struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params {
193 u16 txop;
194 u16 cw_min;
195 u16 cw_max;
196 u8 aifs;
197 bool acm;
198 bool uapsd;
199 bool mu_edca;
200 struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec;
201 };
202
203 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats {
204 unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount;
205 unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount;
206 unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount;
207 unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount;
208 };
209
210 /**
211 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context
212 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed
213 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed
214 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed
215 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel,
216 * this is used only with channel switching with CSA
217 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH: The min required channel width changed
218 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_AP: The AP channel definition changed, so (wider
219 * bandwidth) OFDMA settings need to be changed
220 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_PUNCTURING: The punctured channel(s) bitmap
221 * was changed.
222 */
223 enum ieee80211_chanctx_change {
224 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH = BIT(0),
225 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS = BIT(1),
226 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR = BIT(2),
227 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL = BIT(3),
228 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH = BIT(4),
229 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_AP = BIT(5),
230 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_PUNCTURING = BIT(6),
231 };
232
233 /**
234 * struct ieee80211_chan_req - A channel "request"
235 * @oper: channel definition to use for operation
236 * @ap: the channel definition of the AP, if any
237 * (otherwise the chan member is %NULL)
238 */
239 struct ieee80211_chan_req {
240 struct cfg80211_chan_def oper;
241 struct cfg80211_chan_def ap;
242 };
243
244 /**
245 * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to
246 *
247 * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx
248 * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only.
249 *
250 * @def: the channel definition
251 * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required.
252 * @ap: the channel definition the AP actually is operating as,
253 * for use with (wider bandwidth) OFDMA
254 * @radio_idx: index of the wiphy radio used used for this channel
255 * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be
256 * active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions
257 * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled
258 * after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions;
259 * this will always be >= @rx_chains_static.
260 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel.
261 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
262 * sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information.
263 */
264 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf {
265 struct cfg80211_chan_def def;
266 struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def;
267 struct cfg80211_chan_def ap;
268
269 int radio_idx;
270 u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic;
271
272 bool radar_enabled;
273
274 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
275 };
276
277 /**
278 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode
279 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already
280 * exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface
281 * needs to be switched from one to the other.
282 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop
283 * to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but
284 * will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches
285 * from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course
286 * implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing
287 * hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context
288 * will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used
289 * for changes/removal.)
290 */
291 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode {
292 CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF,
293 CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS,
294 };
295
296 /**
297 * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information
298 *
299 * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that
300 * needs to switch from one chanctx to another. The
301 * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be
302 * done.
303 *
304 * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx
305 * @link_conf: the link conf that's switching
306 * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned
307 * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned
308 */
309 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch {
310 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
311 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf;
312 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx;
313 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx;
314 };
315
316 /**
317 * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags
318 *
319 * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed(), link_info_changed()
320 * and vif_cfg_changed() callbacks to indicate which parameter(s) changed.
321 *
322 * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated),
323 * also implies a change in the AID.
324 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed
325 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed
326 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed
327 * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed
328 * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed
329 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed
330 * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever
331 * reason (IBSS and managed mode)
332 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve
333 * new beacon (beaconing modes)
334 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be
335 * enabled/disabled (beaconing modes)
336 * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed
337 * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed
338 * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed.
339 * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note
340 * that it is only ever disabled for station mode.
341 * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface.
342 * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode)
343 * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode)
344 * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode)
345 * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface
346 * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS)
347 * changed
348 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available:
349 * currently dtim_period only is under consideration.
350 * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed,
351 * note that this is only called when it changes after the channel
352 * context had been assigned.
353 * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed
354 * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed
355 * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected
356 * keep alive) changed.
357 * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface
358 * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder
359 * functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode).
360 * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed
361 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed.
362 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed
363 * @BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY: FILS discovery status changed.
364 * @BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
365 * status changed.
366 * @BSS_CHANGED_MLD_VALID_LINKS: MLD valid links status changed.
367 * @BSS_CHANGED_MLD_TTLM: negotiated TID to link mapping was changed
368 * @BSS_CHANGED_TPE: transmit power envelope changed
369 */
370 enum ieee80211_bss_change {
371 BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC = 1<<0,
372 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT = 1<<1,
373 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE = 1<<2,
374 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT = 1<<3,
375 BSS_CHANGED_HT = 1<<4,
376 BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES = 1<<5,
377 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT = 1<<6,
378 BSS_CHANGED_BSSID = 1<<7,
379 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON = 1<<8,
380 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED = 1<<9,
381 BSS_CHANGED_CQM = 1<<10,
382 BSS_CHANGED_IBSS = 1<<11,
383 BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER = 1<<12,
384 BSS_CHANGED_QOS = 1<<13,
385 BSS_CHANGED_IDLE = 1<<14,
386 BSS_CHANGED_SSID = 1<<15,
387 BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP = 1<<16,
388 BSS_CHANGED_PS = 1<<17,
389 BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER = 1<<18,
390 BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS = 1<<19,
391 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO = 1<<20,
392 BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH = 1<<21,
393 BSS_CHANGED_OCB = 1<<22,
394 BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS = 1<<23,
395 BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE = 1<<24,
396 BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE = 1<<25,
397 BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER = 1<<26,
398 BSS_CHANGED_TWT = 1<<27,
399 BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD = 1<<28,
400 BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR = 1<<29,
401 BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY = 1<<30,
402 BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = BIT_ULL(31),
403 BSS_CHANGED_MLD_VALID_LINKS = BIT_ULL(33),
404 BSS_CHANGED_MLD_TTLM = BIT_ULL(34),
405 BSS_CHANGED_TPE = BIT_ULL(35),
406
407 /* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */
408 };
409
410 /*
411 * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number
412 * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP
413 * filtering will be disabled.
414 */
415 #define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4
416
417 /**
418 * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver
419 * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver.
420 * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME
421 * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received
422 * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because
423 * they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only
424 * once each time the timeout triggers.
425 */
426 enum ieee80211_event_type {
427 RSSI_EVENT,
428 MLME_EVENT,
429 BAR_RX_EVENT,
430 BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT,
431 };
432
433 /**
434 * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT
435 * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver.
436 * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver.
437 */
438 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data {
439 RSSI_EVENT_HIGH,
440 RSSI_EVENT_LOW,
441 };
442
443 /**
444 * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT
445 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data
446 */
447 struct ieee80211_rssi_event {
448 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data;
449 };
450
451 /**
452 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
453 * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication
454 * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association
455 * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received..
456 * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent.
457 */
458 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data {
459 AUTH_EVENT,
460 ASSOC_EVENT,
461 DEAUTH_RX_EVENT,
462 DEAUTH_TX_EVENT,
463 };
464
465 /**
466 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
467 * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully.
468 * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer.
469 * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out.
470 */
471 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status {
472 MLME_SUCCESS,
473 MLME_DENIED,
474 MLME_TIMEOUT,
475 };
476
477 /**
478 * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT
479 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data
480 * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status
481 * @reason: the reason code if applicable
482 */
483 struct ieee80211_mlme_event {
484 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data;
485 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status;
486 u16 reason;
487 };
488
489 /**
490 * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events
491 * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates
492 * @tid: the tid
493 * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT)
494 */
495 struct ieee80211_ba_event {
496 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
497 u16 tid;
498 u16 ssn;
499 };
500
501 /**
502 * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver
503 * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type.
504 * @u.rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT
505 * @u.mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT
506 * @u.ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT
507 * @u:union holding the fields above
508 */
509 struct ieee80211_event {
510 enum ieee80211_event_type type;
511 union {
512 struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi;
513 struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme;
514 struct ieee80211_ba_event ba;
515 } u;
516 };
517
518 /**
519 * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data
520 *
521 * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO
522 *
523 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
524 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
525 */
526 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data {
527 u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN];
528 u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN];
529 };
530
531 /**
532 * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters
533 *
534 * @lci: LCI subelement content
535 * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content
536 * @lci_len: LCI data length
537 * @civicloc_len: Civic data length
538 */
539 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params {
540 const u8 *lci;
541 const u8 *civicloc;
542 size_t lci_len;
543 size_t civicloc_len;
544 };
545
546 /**
547 * struct ieee80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
548 * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
549 *
550 * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
551 * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
552 */
553 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery {
554 u32 min_interval;
555 u32 max_interval;
556 };
557
558 #define IEEE80211_TPE_EIRP_ENTRIES_320MHZ 5
559 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_eirp {
560 bool valid;
561 s8 power[IEEE80211_TPE_EIRP_ENTRIES_320MHZ];
562 u8 count;
563 };
564
565 #define IEEE80211_TPE_PSD_ENTRIES_320MHZ 16
566 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_psd {
567 bool valid;
568 s8 power[IEEE80211_TPE_PSD_ENTRIES_320MHZ];
569 u8 count, n;
570 };
571
572 /**
573 * struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe - parsed transmit power envelope information
574 * @max_local: maximum local EIRP, one value for 20, 40, 80, 160, 320 MHz each
575 * (indexed by TX power category)
576 * @max_reg_client: maximum regulatory client EIRP, one value for 20, 40, 80,
577 * 160, 320 MHz each
578 * (indexed by TX power category)
579 * @psd_local: maximum local power spectral density, one value for each 20 MHz
580 * subchannel per bss_conf's chanreq.oper
581 * (indexed by TX power category)
582 * @psd_reg_client: maximum regulatory power spectral density, one value for
583 * each 20 MHz subchannel per bss_conf's chanreq.oper
584 * (indexed by TX power category)
585 */
586 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe {
587 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_eirp max_local[2], max_reg_client[2];
588 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_psd psd_local[2], psd_reg_client[2];
589 };
590
591 /**
592 * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters
593 *
594 * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association
595 * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS.
596 *
597 * @vif: reference to owning VIF
598 * @bss: the cfg80211 bss descriptor. Valid only for a station, and only
599 * when associated. Note: This contains information which is not
600 * necessarily authenticated. For example, information coming from probe
601 * responses.
602 * @addr: (link) address used locally
603 * @link_id: link ID, or 0 for non-MLO
604 * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE
605 * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP
606 * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field
607 * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us
608 * @he_support: does this BSS support HE
609 * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
610 * mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
611 * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
612 * mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
613 * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames
614 * @twt_broadcast: does this BSS support broadcast TWT
615 * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection
616 * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble
617 * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP)
618 * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing,
619 * valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified
620 * with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then.
621 * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old
622 * as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the
623 * HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can
624 * only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after
625 * association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the
626 * %BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
627 * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf,
628 * the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation
629 * (see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
630 * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY
631 * is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts.
632 * IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync
633 * by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently
634 * guaranteed only in certain callbacks.
635 * Note also that this is not used with MLD associations, mac80211 doesn't
636 * know how to track beacons for all of the links for this.
637 * @beacon_int: beacon interval
638 * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp
639 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an
640 * index into the rate table configured by the driver in
641 * the current band.
642 * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate
643 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
644 * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS
645 * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not
646 * @chanreq: Channel request for this BSS -- the hardware might be
647 * configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example.
648 * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data
649 * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation.
650 * This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel.
651 * Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must
652 * be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT.
653 * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value
654 * implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should
655 * cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in
656 * relation to the newly configured threshold.
657 * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value
658 * implies disabled. This is an alternative mechanism to the single
659 * threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it.
660 * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold.
661 * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis
662 * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS.
663 * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode.
664 * @txpower: TX power in dBm. INT_MIN means not configured.
665 * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit
666 * Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular
667 * TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is
668 * NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from
669 * userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to
670 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace)
671 * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave
672 * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed
673 * to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS
674 * if it has associated clients without P2P PS support.
675 * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from
676 * transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated.
677 * In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include
678 * a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element.
679 * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN
680 * protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the
681 * station.
682 * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM
683 * responder functionality.
684 * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder.
685 * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile
686 * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP
687 * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set
688 * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set
689 * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of
690 * nontransmitted BSSIDs
691 * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received
692 * in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set.
693 * @he_oper: HE operation information of the BSS (AP/Mesh) or of the AP we are
694 * connected to (STA)
695 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters.
696 * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE
697 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery configuration
698 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
699 * interval.
700 * @beacon_tx_rate: The configured beacon transmit rate that needs to be passed
701 * to driver when rate control is offloaded to firmware.
702 * @power_type: power type of BSS for 6 GHz
703 * @tpe: transmit power envelope information
704 * @pwr_reduction: power constraint of BSS.
705 * @eht_support: does this BSS support EHT
706 * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on.
707 * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability
708 * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL
709 * when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX
710 * path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always
711 * be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be
712 * processed after it switches back to %NULL.
713 * @color_change_active: marks whether a color change is ongoing.
714 * @color_change_color: the bss color that will be used after the change.
715 * @ht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HT LDPC capability.
716 * @vht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has VHT LDPC capability.
717 * @he_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HE LDPC capability.
718 * @vht_su_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
719 * beamformer
720 * @vht_su_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
721 * beamformee
722 * @vht_mu_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
723 * beamformer
724 * @vht_mu_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
725 * beamformee
726 * @he_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
727 * beamformer
728 * @he_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
729 * beamformee
730 * @he_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE MU
731 * beamformer
732 * @he_full_ul_mumimo: does this BSS support the reception (AP) or transmission
733 * (non-AP STA) of an HE TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
734 * bandwidth
735 * @eht_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
736 * beamformer
737 * @eht_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
738 * beamformee
739 * @eht_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT MU
740 * beamformer
741 * @eht_80mhz_full_bw_ul_mumimo: in AP-mode, does this BSS support the
742 * reception of an EHT TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
743 * bandwidth
744 */
745 struct ieee80211_bss_conf {
746 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
747 struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
748
749 const u8 *bssid;
750 unsigned int link_id;
751 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
752 u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext;
753 bool uora_exists;
754 u8 uora_ocw_range;
755 u16 frame_time_rts_th;
756 bool he_support;
757 bool twt_requester;
758 bool twt_responder;
759 bool twt_protected;
760 bool twt_broadcast;
761 /* erp related data */
762 bool use_cts_prot;
763 bool use_short_preamble;
764 bool use_short_slot;
765 bool enable_beacon;
766 u8 dtim_period;
767 u16 beacon_int;
768 u16 assoc_capability;
769 u64 sync_tsf;
770 u32 sync_device_ts;
771 u8 sync_dtim_count;
772 u32 basic_rates;
773 struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate;
774 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
775 u16 ht_operation_mode;
776 s32 cqm_rssi_thold;
777 u32 cqm_rssi_hyst;
778 s32 cqm_rssi_low;
779 s32 cqm_rssi_high;
780 struct ieee80211_chan_req chanreq;
781 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group;
782 bool qos;
783 bool hidden_ssid;
784 int txpower;
785 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type;
786 struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr;
787 bool allow_p2p_go_ps;
788 u16 max_idle_period;
789 bool protected_keep_alive;
790 bool ftm_responder;
791 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params;
792 /* Multiple BSSID data */
793 bool nontransmitted;
794 u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
795 u8 bssid_index;
796 u8 bssid_indicator;
797 bool ema_ap;
798 u8 profile_periodicity;
799 struct {
800 u32 params;
801 u16 nss_set;
802 } he_oper;
803 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
804 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
805 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
806 u32 unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval;
807 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_tx_rate;
808 enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power power_type;
809
810 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe tpe;
811
812 u8 pwr_reduction;
813 bool eht_support;
814
815 bool csa_active;
816
817 bool mu_mimo_owner;
818 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf;
819
820 bool color_change_active;
821 u8 color_change_color;
822
823 bool ht_ldpc;
824 bool vht_ldpc;
825 bool he_ldpc;
826 bool vht_su_beamformer;
827 bool vht_su_beamformee;
828 bool vht_mu_beamformer;
829 bool vht_mu_beamformee;
830 bool he_su_beamformer;
831 bool he_su_beamformee;
832 bool he_mu_beamformer;
833 bool he_full_ul_mumimo;
834 bool eht_su_beamformer;
835 bool eht_su_beamformee;
836 bool eht_mu_beamformer;
837 bool eht_80mhz_full_bw_ul_mumimo;
838
839 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
840 };
841
842 /**
843 * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status
844 *
845 * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info.
846 *
847 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame.
848 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence
849 * number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment
850 * number and increasing the sequence number only when the
851 * IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly
852 * assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly
853 * for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from
854 * that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing.
855 * If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to
856 * assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE
857 * 802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for
858 * beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field.
859 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack
860 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination
861 * station
862 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame
863 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon
864 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU
865 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211.
866 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted
867 * because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to
868 * avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or
869 * firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station
870 * went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on
871 * the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for
872 * that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above),
873 * since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the
874 * hardware queue.
875 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged
876 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status
877 * is for the whole aggregation.
878 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned,
879 * so consider using block ack request (BAR).
880 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be
881 * set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will
882 * be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment)
883 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate
884 * that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for
885 * off-channel operation.
886 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation
887 * (header conversion)
888 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211,
889 * used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS
890 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211,
891 * used to indicate frame should not be encrypted
892 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll
893 * frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must
894 * be sent although the station is in powersave mode.
895 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the
896 * transmit function after the current frame, this can be used
897 * by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the
898 * queue gets full.
899 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted
900 * after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not
901 * be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.)
902 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME
903 * code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status
904 * should kick the MLME state machine.
905 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211
906 * MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX
907 * status to user space)
908 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame
909 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this
910 * frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use.
911 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on
912 * the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done
913 * in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be
914 * handled properly by the device.
915 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP
916 * testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow
917 * TKIP countermeasures to be tested.
918 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate.
919 * This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P
920 * frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band.
921 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period,
922 * when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in
923 * an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames
924 * the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for
925 * PS-Poll responses.
926 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate.
927 * This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when
928 * the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose.
929 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it
930 * would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for
931 * monitor injection).
932 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with
933 * IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without
934 * any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW).
935 * This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack
936 * behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK.
937 *
938 * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't
939 * forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary.
940 */
941 enum mac80211_tx_info_flags {
942 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS = BIT(0),
943 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ = BIT(1),
944 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK = BIT(2),
945 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT = BIT(3),
946 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT = BIT(4),
947 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM = BIT(5),
948 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU = BIT(6),
949 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED = BIT(7),
950 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED = BIT(8),
951 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK = BIT(9),
952 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU = BIT(10),
953 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK = BIT(11),
954 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE = BIT(12),
955 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK = BIT(13),
956 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP = BIT(14),
957 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED = BIT(15),
958 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT = BIT(16),
959 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER = BIT(17),
960 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES = BIT(18),
961 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION = BIT(19),
962 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX = BIT(20),
963 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX = BIT(21),
964 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC = BIT(22),
965 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC = BIT(23) | BIT(24),
966 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN = BIT(25),
967 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE = BIT(26),
968 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE = BIT(27),
969 IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP = BIT(28),
970 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE = BIT(29),
971 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG = BIT(30),
972 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED = BIT(31),
973 };
974
975 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT 23
976
977 #define IEEE80211_TX_RC_S1G_MCS IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS
978
979 /**
980 * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control
981 *
982 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control
983 * protocol frame (e.g. EAP)
984 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll
985 * frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD).
986 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information
987 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame
988 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path
989 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup
990 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211,
991 * used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before
992 * it can be sent out.
993 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that
994 * has already been assigned to this frame.
995 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER: This frame should not be reordered
996 * relative to other frames that have this flag set, independent
997 * of their QoS TID or other priority field values.
998 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX: first MLO TX, used mostly internally
999 * for sequence number assignment
1000 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_USE_RATE_MASK: Don't use rate mask for this frame
1001 * which is transmitted due to scanning or offchannel TX, not in normal
1002 * operation on the interface.
1003 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK: If not @IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, this
1004 * frame should be transmitted on the specific link. This really is
1005 * only relevant for frames that do not have data present, and is
1006 * also not used for 802.3 format frames. Note that even if the frame
1007 * is on a specific link, address translation might still apply if
1008 * it's intended for an MLD.
1009 *
1010 * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags.
1011 */
1012 enum mac80211_tx_control_flags {
1013 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO = BIT(0),
1014 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE = BIT(1),
1015 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT = BIT(2),
1016 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU = BIT(3),
1017 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT = BIT(4),
1018 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP = BIT(5),
1019 IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING = BIT(6),
1020 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO = BIT(7),
1021 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER = BIT(8),
1022 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX = BIT(9),
1023 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_USE_RATE_MASK = BIT(10),
1024 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK = 0xf0000000,
1025 };
1026
1027 #define IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED 0xf
1028 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK_UNSPEC \
1029 u32_encode_bits(IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, \
1030 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK)
1031
1032 /**
1033 * enum mac80211_tx_status_flags - flags to describe transmit status
1034 *
1035 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID: ACK signal is valid
1036 *
1037 * These flags are used in tx_info->status.flags.
1038 */
1039 enum mac80211_tx_status_flags {
1040 IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID = BIT(0),
1041 };
1042
1043 /*
1044 * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are
1045 * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack.
1046 */
1047 #define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK | \
1048 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT | \
1049 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU | \
1050 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK | \
1051 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK | \
1052 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER | \
1053 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC | \
1054 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
1055
1056 /**
1057 * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the
1058 * Rate Control algorithm.
1059 *
1060 * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx,
1061 * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate.
1062 *
1063 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate.
1064 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required.
1065 * This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection.
1066 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble.
1067 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate.
1068 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split
1069 * into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number)
1070 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in
1071 * Greenfield mode.
1072 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz.
1073 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission
1074 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission
1075 * (80+80 isn't supported yet)
1076 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the
1077 * adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is
1078 * NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS.
1079 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate.
1080 */
1081 enum mac80211_rate_control_flags {
1082 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS = BIT(0),
1083 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT = BIT(1),
1084 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE = BIT(2),
1085
1086 /* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */
1087 IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS = BIT(3),
1088 IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD = BIT(4),
1089 IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(5),
1090 IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA = BIT(6),
1091 IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI = BIT(7),
1092 IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS = BIT(8),
1093 IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(9),
1094 IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(10),
1095 };
1096
1097
1098 /* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */
1099 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40
1100
1101 /* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */
1102 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24
1103
1104 /* maximum number of rate stages */
1105 #define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES 4
1106
1107 /* maximum number of rate table entries */
1108 #define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE 4
1109
1110 /**
1111 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status
1112 *
1113 * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with
1114 * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags)
1115 * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate
1116 *
1117 * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used
1118 * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried.
1119 *
1120 * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should
1121 * always report the rate along with the flags it used.
1122 *
1123 * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs
1124 * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate
1125 * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example,
1126 * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the
1127 * information::
1128 *
1129 * { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 }
1130 *
1131 * then this means that the frame should be transmitted
1132 * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four
1133 * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets
1134 * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status
1135 * information should then contain::
1136 *
1137 * { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ...
1138 *
1139 * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2
1140 * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement.
1141 */
1142 struct ieee80211_tx_rate {
1143 s8 idx;
1144 u16 count:5,
1145 flags:11;
1146 } __packed;
1147
1148 #define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY 31
1149
ieee80211_rate_valid(struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1150 static inline bool ieee80211_rate_valid(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1151 {
1152 return rate->idx >= 0 && rate->count > 0;
1153 }
1154
ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate,u8 mcs,u8 nss)1155 static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate,
1156 u8 mcs, u8 nss)
1157 {
1158 WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF);
1159 WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7);
1160 rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs;
1161 }
1162
1163 static inline u8
ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1164 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1165 {
1166 return rate->idx & 0xF;
1167 }
1168
1169 static inline u8
ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1170 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1171 {
1172 return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1;
1173 }
1174
1175 /**
1176 * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information
1177 *
1178 * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses:
1179 * (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do
1180 * (2) driver internal use (if applicable)
1181 * (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened
1182 *
1183 * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above
1184 * @band: the band to transmit on (use e.g. for checking for races),
1185 * not valid if the interface is an MLD since we won't know which
1186 * link the frame will be transmitted on
1187 * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC
1188 * @status_data: internal data for TX status handling, assigned privately,
1189 * see also &enum ieee80211_status_data for the internal documentation
1190 * @status_data_idr: indicates status data is IDR allocated ID for ack frame
1191 * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally
1192 * @control: union part for control data
1193 * @control.rates: TX rates array to try
1194 * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS
1195 * @control.use_rts: use RTS
1196 * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS
1197 * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only)
1198 * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table
1199 * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients
1200 * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL)
1201 * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL)
1202 * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags
1203 * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs)
1204 * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space
1205 * @pad: padding
1206 * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates
1207 * @status: union part for status data
1208 * @status.rates: attempted rates
1209 * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal
1210 * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length
1211 * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length
1212 * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy)
1213 * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission; note this is only
1214 * used for WMM AC, not for airtime fairness
1215 * @status.flags: status flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_status_flags
1216 * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area
1217 * @ack: union part for pure ACK data
1218 * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK
1219 * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers
1220 */
1221 struct ieee80211_tx_info {
1222 /* common information */
1223 u32 flags;
1224 u32 band:3,
1225 status_data_idr:1,
1226 status_data:13,
1227 hw_queue:4,
1228 tx_time_est:10;
1229 /* 1 free bit */
1230
1231 union {
1232 struct {
1233 union {
1234 /* rate control */
1235 struct {
1236 struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[
1237 IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1238 s8 rts_cts_rate_idx;
1239 u8 use_rts:1;
1240 u8 use_cts_prot:1;
1241 u8 short_preamble:1;
1242 u8 skip_table:1;
1243
1244 /* for injection only (bitmap) */
1245 u8 antennas:2;
1246
1247 /* 14 bits free */
1248 };
1249 /* only needed before rate control */
1250 unsigned long jiffies;
1251 };
1252 /* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */
1253 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
1254 struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key;
1255 u32 flags;
1256 codel_time_t enqueue_time;
1257 } control;
1258 struct {
1259 u64 cookie;
1260 } ack;
1261 struct {
1262 struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1263 s32 ack_signal;
1264 u8 ampdu_ack_len;
1265 u8 ampdu_len;
1266 u8 antenna;
1267 u8 pad;
1268 u16 tx_time;
1269 u8 flags;
1270 u8 pad2;
1271 void *status_driver_data[16 / sizeof(void *)];
1272 } status;
1273 struct {
1274 struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[
1275 IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1276 u8 pad[4];
1277
1278 void *rate_driver_data[
1279 IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1280 };
1281
1282 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
1283
1284 void *driver_data[
1285 IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1286 };
1287 };
1288
1289 static inline u16
ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info,u16 tx_time_est)1290 ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est)
1291 {
1292 /* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime
1293 * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1
1294 */
1295 info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2;
1296 return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1297 }
1298
1299 static inline u16
ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)1300 ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1301 {
1302 return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1303 }
1304
1305 /***
1306 * struct ieee80211_rate_status - mrr stage for status path
1307 *
1308 * This struct is used in struct ieee80211_tx_status to provide drivers a
1309 * dynamic way to report about used rates and power levels per packet.
1310 *
1311 * @rate_idx The actual used rate.
1312 * @try_count How often the rate was tried.
1313 * @tx_power_idx An idx into the ieee80211_hw->tx_power_levels list of the
1314 * corresponding wifi hardware. The idx shall point to the power level
1315 * that was used when sending the packet.
1316 */
1317 struct ieee80211_rate_status {
1318 struct rate_info rate_idx;
1319 u8 try_count;
1320 u8 tx_power_idx;
1321 };
1322
1323 /**
1324 * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control
1325 *
1326 * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for
1327 * @info: Basic tx status information
1328 * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver)
1329 * @rates: Mrr stages that were used when sending the packet
1330 * @n_rates: Number of mrr stages (count of instances for @rates)
1331 * @free_list: list where processed skbs are stored to be free'd by the driver
1332 * @ack_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp of the received ack in nanoseconds
1333 * Only needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action
1334 * frames. Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1335 */
1336 struct ieee80211_tx_status {
1337 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
1338 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info;
1339 struct sk_buff *skb;
1340 struct ieee80211_rate_status *rates;
1341 ktime_t ack_hwtstamp;
1342 u8 n_rates;
1343
1344 struct list_head *free_list;
1345 };
1346
1347 /**
1348 * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs
1349 *
1350 * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan
1351 * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace
1352 * and the ones generated by mac80211.
1353 *
1354 * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs.
1355 * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs.
1356 * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones)
1357 * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies
1358 */
1359 struct ieee80211_scan_ies {
1360 const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1361 size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1362 const u8 *common_ies;
1363 size_t common_ie_len;
1364 };
1365
1366
IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff * skb)1367 static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1368 {
1369 return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb;
1370 }
1371
IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff * skb)1372 static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1373 {
1374 return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb;
1375 }
1376
1377 /**
1378 * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status
1379 *
1380 * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared.
1381 *
1382 * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report
1383 * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything
1384 * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear
1385 * the count since you need to fill that in anyway).
1386 *
1387 * NOTE: While the rates array is kept intact, this will wipe all of the
1388 * driver_data fields in info, so it's up to the driver to restore
1389 * any fields it needs after calling this helper.
1390 */
1391 static inline void
ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)1392 ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1393 {
1394 int i;
1395
1396 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1397 offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates));
1398 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1399 offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates));
1400 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8);
1401 /* clear the rate counts */
1402 for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++)
1403 info->status.rates[i].count = 0;
1404 memset_after(&info->status, 0, rates);
1405 }
1406
1407
1408 /**
1409 * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags
1410 *
1411 * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status.
1412 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame.
1413 * Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED.
1414 * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware.
1415 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame,
1416 * verification has been done by the hardware.
1417 * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame.
1418 * If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection
1419 * hence the driver or hardware will have to do that.
1420 * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this
1421 * flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection.
1422 * Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame
1423 * is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set)
1424 * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did
1425 * de-duplication by itself.
1426 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on
1427 * the frame.
1428 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on
1429 * the frame.
1430 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1431 * field) is valid if this field is non-zero, and the position
1432 * where the timestamp was sampled depends on the value.
1433 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1434 * field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU
1435 * was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS
1436 * merging.
1437 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1438 * field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU
1439 * (including FCS) was received.
1440 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1441 * field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received.
1442 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_IS_RTAP_TS64: The timestamp passed in the RX status @mactime
1443 * is only for use in the radiotap timestamp header, not otherwise a valid
1444 * @mactime value. Note this is a separate flag so that we continue to see
1445 * %RX_FLAG_MACTIME as unset. Also note that in this case the timestamp is
1446 * reported to be 64 bits wide, not just 32.
1447 * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present.
1448 * Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU)
1449 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference
1450 * number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for
1451 * each A-MPDU
1452 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all
1453 * subframes of a single A-MPDU
1454 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU
1455 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected
1456 * on this subframe
1457 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN: The delimiter CRC field is known (the CRC
1458 * is stored in the @ampdu_delimiter_crc field)
1459 * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was
1460 * done by the hardware
1461 * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without
1462 * processing it in any regular way.
1463 * This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1464 * them for sniffing purposes.
1465 * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except
1466 * monitor interfaces.
1467 * This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1468 * them for sniffing purposes.
1469 * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU
1470 * subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons.
1471 * All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g.
1472 * if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while
1473 * the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to
1474 * deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU
1475 * subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be
1476 * either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be
1477 * interleaved with other frames.
1478 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END: This frame contains radiotap TLVs in the
1479 * skb->data (before the 802.11 header).
1480 * If used, the SKB's mac_header pointer must be set to point
1481 * to the 802.11 header after the TLVs, and any padding added after TLV
1482 * data to align to 4 must be cleared by the driver putting the TLVs
1483 * in the skb.
1484 * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before.
1485 * This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as
1486 * the first subframe.
1487 * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must
1488 * be done in the hardware.
1489 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this
1490 * frame
1491 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known
1492 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present
1493 * (&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in
1494 *
1495 * - DATA3_DATA_MCS
1496 * - DATA3_DATA_DCM
1497 * - DATA3_CODING
1498 * - DATA5_GI
1499 * - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC
1500 * - DATA6_NSTS
1501 * - DATA3_STBC
1502 *
1503 * from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data)
1504 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present
1505 * (&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu)
1506 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present
1507 * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with
1508 * the "0-length PSDU" field included there. The value for it is
1509 * in &struct ieee80211_rx_status. Note that if this value isn't
1510 * known the frame shouldn't be reported.
1511 * @RX_FLAG_8023: the frame has an 802.3 header (decap offload performed by
1512 * hardware or driver)
1513 */
1514 enum mac80211_rx_flags {
1515 RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR = BIT(0),
1516 RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED = BIT(1),
1517 RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR = BIT(2),
1518 RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED = BIT(3),
1519 RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED = BIT(4),
1520 RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC = BIT(5),
1521 RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC = BIT(6),
1522 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_IS_RTAP_TS64 = BIT(7),
1523 RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL = BIT(8),
1524 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS = BIT(9),
1525 RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED = BIT(10),
1526 RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED = BIT(11),
1527 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN = BIT(12),
1528 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST = BIT(13),
1529 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR = BIT(14),
1530 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN = BIT(15),
1531 RX_FLAG_MACTIME = BIT(16) | BIT(17),
1532 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START = 1 << 16,
1533 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START = 2 << 16,
1534 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END = 3 << 16,
1535 RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR = BIT(18),
1536 RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE = BIT(19),
1537 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END = BIT(20),
1538 RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED = BIT(21),
1539 RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN = BIT(22),
1540 RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED = BIT(23),
1541 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT = BIT(24),
1542 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN = BIT(25),
1543 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE = BIT(26),
1544 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU = BIT(27),
1545 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG = BIT(28),
1546 RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU = BIT(29),
1547 RX_FLAG_8023 = BIT(30),
1548 };
1549
1550 /**
1551 * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags
1552 *
1553 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame
1554 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used
1555 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission,
1556 * if the driver fills this value it should add
1557 * %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT
1558 * to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact.
1559 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used
1560 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3
1561 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed
1562 */
1563 enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags {
1564 RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE = BIT(0),
1565 RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI = BIT(2),
1566 RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF = BIT(3),
1567 RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK = BIT(4) | BIT(5),
1568 RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC = BIT(6),
1569 RX_ENC_FLAG_BF = BIT(7),
1570 };
1571
1572 #define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT 4
1573
1574 enum mac80211_rx_encoding {
1575 RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0,
1576 RX_ENC_HT,
1577 RX_ENC_VHT,
1578 RX_ENC_HE,
1579 RX_ENC_EHT,
1580 };
1581
1582 /**
1583 * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status
1584 *
1585 * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset
1586 * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received
1587 * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb).
1588 *
1589 * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function
1590 * (TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware.
1591 * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is
1592 * needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache.
1593 * @ack_tx_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp for the ack TX in nanoseconds. Only
1594 * needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action frames.
1595 * Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1596 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use
1597 * it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation
1598 * @band: the active band when this frame was received
1599 * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz
1600 * This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed
1601 * for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting.
1602 * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz.
1603 * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or
1604 * unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags
1605 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_*
1606 * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength
1607 * values were filled.
1608 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't
1609 * support dB or unspecified units)
1610 * @antenna: antenna used
1611 * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if
1612 * HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT)
1613 * @nss: number of streams (VHT, HE and EHT only)
1614 * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\*
1615 * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding
1616 * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw
1617 * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags
1618 * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc
1619 * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi
1620 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1621 * @eht: EHT specific rate information
1622 * @eht.ru: EHT RU, from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc
1623 * @eht.gi: EHT GI, from &enum nl80211_eht_gi
1624 * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211
1625 * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for
1626 * each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU
1627 * @ampdu_delimiter_crc: A-MPDU delimiter CRC
1628 * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU
1629 * @link_valid: if the link which is identified by @link_id is valid. This flag
1630 * is set only when connection is MLO.
1631 * @link_id: id of the link used to receive the packet. This is used along with
1632 * @link_valid.
1633 */
1634 struct ieee80211_rx_status {
1635 u64 mactime;
1636 union {
1637 u64 boottime_ns;
1638 ktime_t ack_tx_hwtstamp;
1639 };
1640 u32 device_timestamp;
1641 u32 ampdu_reference;
1642 u32 flag;
1643 u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1;
1644 u8 enc_flags;
1645 u8 encoding:3, bw:4;
1646 union {
1647 struct {
1648 u8 he_ru:3;
1649 u8 he_gi:2;
1650 u8 he_dcm:1;
1651 };
1652 struct {
1653 u8 ru:4;
1654 u8 gi:2;
1655 } eht;
1656 };
1657 u8 rate_idx;
1658 u8 nss;
1659 u8 rx_flags;
1660 u8 band;
1661 u8 antenna;
1662 s8 signal;
1663 u8 chains;
1664 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1665 u8 ampdu_delimiter_crc;
1666 u8 zero_length_psdu_type;
1667 u8 link_valid:1, link_id:4;
1668 };
1669
1670 static inline u32
ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status * rx_status)1671 ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status)
1672 {
1673 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) +
1674 (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0);
1675 }
1676
1677 /**
1678 * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags
1679 *
1680 * Flags to define PHY configuration options
1681 *
1682 * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this
1683 * to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets
1684 * or not, do not use instead of filter flags!
1685 * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only).
1686 * This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2,
1687 * meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to
1688 * transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames.
1689 * Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states,
1690 * driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support"
1691 * for more.
1692 * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set
1693 * the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but
1694 * may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will
1695 * be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but
1696 * it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active.
1697 * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main
1698 * operating channel.
1699 */
1700 enum ieee80211_conf_flags {
1701 IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR = (1<<0),
1702 IEEE80211_CONF_PS = (1<<1),
1703 IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE = (1<<2),
1704 IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL = (1<<3),
1705 };
1706
1707
1708 /**
1709 * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed
1710 *
1711 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed
1712 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed
1713 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed
1714 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed
1715 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed
1716 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed
1717 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed
1718 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed
1719 * Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1720 * otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1721 */
1722 enum ieee80211_conf_changed {
1723 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS = BIT(1),
1724 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL = BIT(2),
1725 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR = BIT(3),
1726 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS = BIT(4),
1727 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER = BIT(5),
1728 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL = BIT(6),
1729 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS = BIT(7),
1730 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE = BIT(8),
1731 };
1732
1733 /**
1734 * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode
1735 *
1736 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic
1737 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off
1738 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static
1739 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic
1740 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use
1741 */
1742 enum ieee80211_smps_mode {
1743 IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC,
1744 IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF,
1745 IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC,
1746 IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
1747
1748 /* keep last */
1749 IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES,
1750 };
1751
1752 /**
1753 * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device
1754 *
1755 * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware.
1756 *
1757 * @flags: configuration flags defined above
1758 *
1759 * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval
1760 * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use
1761 * in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon
1762 * has been received and the DTIM period is known.
1763 * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the
1764 * powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when
1765 * the CONF_PS flag is set.
1766 *
1767 * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility
1768 * value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces
1769 *
1770 * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to
1771 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled
1772 *
1773 * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame
1774 * (a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11,
1775 * but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries
1776 * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short"
1777 * frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the
1778 * number of transmissions not the number of retries
1779 *
1780 * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that
1781 * %IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not
1782 * configured for an HT channel.
1783 * Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1784 * otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1785 */
1786 struct ieee80211_conf {
1787 u32 flags;
1788 int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout;
1789
1790 u16 listen_interval;
1791 u8 ps_dtim_period;
1792
1793 u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count;
1794
1795 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1796 bool radar_enabled;
1797 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1798
1799 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
1800 };
1801
1802 /**
1803 * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data
1804 *
1805 * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch
1806 * operation.
1807 *
1808 * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization
1809 * Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch
1810 * announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter
1811 * the driver passed into mac80211.
1812 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the
1813 * rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211.
1814 * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the
1815 * scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP.
1816 * @chandef: the new channel to switch to
1817 * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event
1818 * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in
1819 * current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new
1820 * channel, expressed in TU.
1821 * @link_id: the link ID of the link doing the channel switch, 0 for non-MLO
1822 */
1823 struct ieee80211_channel_switch {
1824 u64 timestamp;
1825 u32 device_timestamp;
1826 bool block_tx;
1827 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1828 u8 count;
1829 u8 link_id;
1830 u32 delay;
1831 };
1832
1833 /**
1834 * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags
1835 *
1836 * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering
1837 * on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups
1838 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality
1839 * monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor
1840 * connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and
1841 * provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached.
1842 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this
1843 * interface. This flag should be set during interface addition,
1844 * but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is
1845 * only valid for managed/station mode interfaces.
1846 * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes
1847 * and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even
1848 * this is not pure P2P vif.
1849 * @IEEE80211_VIF_EML_ACTIVE: The driver indicates that EML operation is
1850 * enabled for the interface.
1851 * @IEEE80211_VIF_IGNORE_OFDMA_WIDER_BW: Ignore wider bandwidth OFDMA
1852 * operation on this interface and request a channel context without
1853 * the AP definition. Use this e.g. because the device is able to
1854 * handle OFDMA (downlink and trigger for uplink) on a per-AP basis.
1855 */
1856 enum ieee80211_vif_flags {
1857 IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER = BIT(0),
1858 IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI = BIT(1),
1859 IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD = BIT(2),
1860 IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE = BIT(3),
1861 IEEE80211_VIF_EML_ACTIVE = BIT(4),
1862 IEEE80211_VIF_IGNORE_OFDMA_WIDER_BW = BIT(5),
1863 };
1864
1865
1866 /**
1867 * enum ieee80211_offload_flags - virtual interface offload flags
1868 *
1869 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED: tx encapsulation offload is enabled
1870 * The driver supports sending frames passed as 802.3 frames by mac80211.
1871 * It must also support sending 802.11 packets for the same interface.
1872 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR: support 4-address mode encapsulation offload
1873 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED: rx encapsulation offload is enabled
1874 * The driver supports passing received 802.11 frames as 802.3 frames to
1875 * mac80211.
1876 */
1877
1878 enum ieee80211_offload_flags {
1879 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED = BIT(0),
1880 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR = BIT(1),
1881 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED = BIT(2),
1882 };
1883
1884 /**
1885 * struct ieee80211_vif_cfg - interface configuration
1886 * @assoc: association status
1887 * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS or not
1888 * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created
1889 * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by
1890 * offchannel/dynamic_ps operations.
1891 * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true
1892 * @eml_cap: EML capabilities as described in P802.11be_D4.1 Figure 9-1001j.
1893 * @eml_med_sync_delay: Medium Synchronization delay as described in
1894 * P802.11be_D4.1 Figure 9-1001i.
1895 * @mld_capa_op: MLD Capabilities and Operations per P802.11be_D4.1
1896 * Figure 9-1001k
1897 * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The
1898 * may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here.
1899 * The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here
1900 * to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass.
1901 * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this
1902 * may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list
1903 * array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case.
1904 * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode.
1905 * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid.
1906 * @s1g: BSS is S1G BSS (affects Association Request format).
1907 * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the
1908 * hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what
1909 * your driver/device needs to do.
1910 * @ap_addr: AP MLD address, or BSSID for non-MLO connections
1911 * (station mode only)
1912 */
1913 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg {
1914 /* association related data */
1915 bool assoc, ibss_joined;
1916 bool ibss_creator;
1917 bool ps;
1918 u16 aid;
1919 u16 eml_cap;
1920 u16 eml_med_sync_delay;
1921 u16 mld_capa_op;
1922
1923 __be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN];
1924 int arp_addr_cnt;
1925 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
1926 size_t ssid_len;
1927 bool s1g;
1928 bool idle;
1929 u8 ap_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1930 };
1931
1932 #define IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS 8
1933
1934 /**
1935 * struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm - negotiated TID to link map info
1936 *
1937 * @downlink: bitmap of active links per TID for downlink, or 0 if mapping for
1938 * this TID is not included.
1939 * @uplink: bitmap of active links per TID for uplink, or 0 if mapping for this
1940 * TID is not included.
1941 * @valid: info is valid or not.
1942 */
1943 struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm {
1944 u16 downlink[IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS];
1945 u16 uplink[IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS];
1946 bool valid;
1947 };
1948
1949 /**
1950 * enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res - return value for negotiated TTLM handling
1951 * @NEG_TTLM_RES_ACCEPT: accept the request
1952 * @NEG_TTLM_RES_REJECT: reject the request
1953 * @NEG_TTLM_RES_SUGGEST_PREFERRED: reject and suggest a new mapping
1954 */
1955 enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res {
1956 NEG_TTLM_RES_ACCEPT,
1957 NEG_TTLM_RES_REJECT,
1958 NEG_TTLM_RES_SUGGEST_PREFERRED
1959 };
1960
1961 /**
1962 * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data
1963 *
1964 * Data in this structure is continually present for driver
1965 * use during the life of a virtual interface.
1966 *
1967 * @type: type of this virtual interface
1968 * @cfg: vif configuration, see &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg
1969 * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own
1970 * or the BSS we're associated to
1971 * @link_conf: in case of MLD, the per-link BSS configuration,
1972 * indexed by link ID
1973 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1974 * @active_links: The bitmap of active links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1975 * The driver shouldn't change this directly, but use the
1976 * API calls meant for that purpose.
1977 * @dormant_links: subset of the valid links that are disabled/suspended
1978 * due to advertised or negotiated TTLM respectively.
1979 * 0 for non-MLO.
1980 * @suspended_links: subset of dormant_links representing links that are
1981 * suspended due to negotiated TTLM, and could be activated in the
1982 * future by tearing down the TTLM negotiation.
1983 * 0 for non-MLO.
1984 * @neg_ttlm: negotiated TID to link mapping info.
1985 * see &struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm.
1986 * @addr: address of this interface
1987 * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p
1988 * interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively
1989 * @netdev_features: tx netdev features supported by the hardware for this
1990 * vif. mac80211 initializes this to hw->netdev_features, and the driver
1991 * can mask out specific tx features. mac80211 will handle software fixup
1992 * for masked offloads (GSO, CSUM)
1993 * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface,
1994 * these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added
1995 * or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed
1996 * at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field
1997 * @offload_flags: hardware offload capabilities/flags for this interface.
1998 * These are initialized by mac80211 before calling .add_interface,
1999 * .change_interface or .update_vif_offload and updated by the driver
2000 * within these ops, based on supported features or runtime change
2001 * restrictions.
2002 * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC
2003 * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only
2004 * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per
2005 * interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual
2006 * monitor interface (if that is requested.)
2007 * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this
2008 * interface.
2009 * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211
2010 * for this interface.
2011 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2012 * sizeof(void \*).
2013 * @txq: the multicast data TX queue
2014 * @offload_flags: 802.3 -> 802.11 enapsulation offload flags, see
2015 * &enum ieee80211_offload_flags.
2016 * @mbssid_tx_vif: Pointer to the transmitting interface if MBSSID is enabled.
2017 */
2018 struct ieee80211_vif {
2019 enum nl80211_iftype type;
2020 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg cfg;
2021 struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf;
2022 struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *link_conf[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2023 u16 valid_links, active_links, dormant_links, suspended_links;
2024 struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm neg_ttlm;
2025 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2026 bool p2p;
2027
2028 u8 cab_queue;
2029 u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
2030
2031 struct ieee80211_txq *txq;
2032
2033 netdev_features_t netdev_features;
2034 u32 driver_flags;
2035 u32 offload_flags;
2036
2037 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
2038 struct dentry *debugfs_dir;
2039 #endif
2040
2041 bool probe_req_reg;
2042 bool rx_mcast_action_reg;
2043
2044 struct ieee80211_vif *mbssid_tx_vif;
2045
2046 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
2047
2048 /* must be last */
2049 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2050 };
2051
2052 /**
2053 * ieee80211_vif_usable_links - Return the usable links for the vif
2054 * @vif: the vif for which the usable links are requested
2055 * Return: the usable link bitmap
2056 */
ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2057 static inline u16 ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2058 {
2059 return vif->valid_links & ~vif->dormant_links;
2060 }
2061
2062 /**
2063 * ieee80211_vif_is_mld - Returns true iff the vif is an MLD one
2064 * @vif: the vif
2065 * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD, %false otherwise.
2066 */
ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2067 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2068 {
2069 /* valid_links != 0 indicates this vif is an MLD */
2070 return vif->valid_links != 0;
2071 }
2072
2073 /**
2074 * ieee80211_vif_link_active - check if a given link is active
2075 * @vif: the vif
2076 * @link_id: the link ID to check
2077 * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD and the link is active, or if
2078 * the vif is not an MLD and the link ID is 0; %false otherwise.
2079 */
ieee80211_vif_link_active(const struct ieee80211_vif * vif,unsigned int link_id)2080 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_link_active(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
2081 unsigned int link_id)
2082 {
2083 if (!ieee80211_vif_is_mld(vif))
2084 return link_id == 0;
2085 return vif->active_links & BIT(link_id);
2086 }
2087
2088 #define for_each_vif_active_link(vif, link, link_id) \
2089 for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((vif)->link_conf); link_id++) \
2090 if ((!(vif)->active_links || \
2091 (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) && \
2092 (link = link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id)))
2093
ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2094 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2095 {
2096 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH
2097 return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT;
2098 #endif
2099 return false;
2100 }
2101
2102 /**
2103 * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev
2104 * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for
2105 *
2106 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
2107 * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev.
2108 *
2109 * Return: pointer to the wdev, or %NULL if the given wdev isn't
2110 * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
2111 * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
2112 */
2113 struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
2114
2115 /**
2116 * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif
2117 * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for
2118 *
2119 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
2120 * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif.
2121 * This can also be useful to get the netdev associated to a vif.
2122 *
2123 * Return: pointer to the wdev
2124 */
2125 struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
2126
lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2127 static inline bool lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2128 {
2129 return lockdep_is_held(&ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(vif)->wiphy->mtx);
2130 }
2131
2132 #define link_conf_dereference_protected(vif, link_id) \
2133 rcu_dereference_protected((vif)->link_conf[link_id], \
2134 lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif))
2135
2136 #define link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id) \
2137 rcu_dereference_check((vif)->link_conf[link_id], \
2138 lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif))
2139
2140 /**
2141 * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags
2142 *
2143 * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver
2144 * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf.
2145 *
2146 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the
2147 * driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this
2148 * particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs
2149 * will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC.
2150 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by
2151 * the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC
2152 * generation in software.
2153 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
2154 * that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key.
2155 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a
2156 * CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames
2157 * (MFP) to be done in software.
2158 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver
2159 * if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV
2160 * itself should not be generated. Do not set together with
2161 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does
2162 * not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or
2163 * MIC.
2164 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received
2165 * management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware
2166 * crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames
2167 * properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and
2168 * fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with
2169 * RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the
2170 * %IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW.
2171 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the
2172 * driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation
2173 * only for management frames (MFP).
2174 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the
2175 * driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always
2176 * be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled.
2177 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for
2178 * a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with
2179 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key.
2180 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation.
2181 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver
2182 * for a AES_CMAC or a AES_GMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence
2183 * number generation only
2184 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU: SPP A-MSDUs can be used with this key
2185 * (set by mac80211 from the sta->spp_amsdu flag)
2186 */
2187 enum ieee80211_key_flags {
2188 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT = BIT(0),
2189 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV = BIT(1),
2190 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC = BIT(2),
2191 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE = BIT(3),
2192 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX = BIT(4),
2193 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE = BIT(5),
2194 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT = BIT(6),
2195 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM = BIT(7),
2196 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE = BIT(8),
2197 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX = BIT(9),
2198 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE = BIT(10),
2199 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU = BIT(11),
2200 };
2201
2202 /**
2203 * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information
2204 *
2205 * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by
2206 * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops.
2207 *
2208 * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver
2209 * wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be
2210 * encrypted in hardware.
2211 * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector.
2212 * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it
2213 * needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO)
2214 * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags.
2215 * @keyidx: the key index (0-3)
2216 * @keylen: key material length
2217 * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte)
2218 * data block:
2219 * - Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits)
2220 * - Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits)
2221 * - Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits)
2222 * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type
2223 * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type
2224 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, or -1 for non-MLO or pairwise keys
2225 */
2226 struct ieee80211_key_conf {
2227 atomic64_t tx_pn;
2228 u32 cipher;
2229 u8 icv_len;
2230 u8 iv_len;
2231 u8 hw_key_idx;
2232 s8 keyidx;
2233 u16 flags;
2234 s8 link_id;
2235 u8 keylen;
2236 u8 key[];
2237 };
2238
2239 #define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN 16
2240
2241 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff))
2242 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff))
2243
2244 /**
2245 * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter
2246 *
2247 * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order
2248 * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2249 * reverse order than in packet)
2250 * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2251 * reverse order than in packet)
2252 * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2253 * reverse order than in packet)
2254 * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2255 * reverse order than in packet)
2256 * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys
2257 */
2258 struct ieee80211_key_seq {
2259 union {
2260 struct {
2261 u32 iv32;
2262 u16 iv16;
2263 } tkip;
2264 struct {
2265 u8 pn[6];
2266 } ccmp;
2267 struct {
2268 u8 pn[6];
2269 } aes_cmac;
2270 struct {
2271 u8 pn[6];
2272 } aes_gmac;
2273 struct {
2274 u8 pn[6];
2275 } gcmp;
2276 struct {
2277 u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN];
2278 u8 seq_len;
2279 } hw;
2280 };
2281 };
2282
2283 /**
2284 * enum set_key_cmd - key command
2285 *
2286 * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2287 * indicates whether a key is being removed or added.
2288 *
2289 * @SET_KEY: a key is set
2290 * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled
2291 */
2292 enum set_key_cmd {
2293 SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY,
2294 };
2295
2296 /**
2297 * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state
2298 *
2299 * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all,
2300 * this is a special state for add/remove transitions
2301 * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state
2302 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated
2303 * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated
2304 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
2305 */
2306 enum ieee80211_sta_state {
2307 /* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */
2308 IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST,
2309 IEEE80211_STA_NONE,
2310 IEEE80211_STA_AUTH,
2311 IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC,
2312 IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED,
2313 };
2314
2315 /**
2316 * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth
2317 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz
2318 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz
2319 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz
2320 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz
2321 * (including 80+80 MHz)
2322 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320: station can receive up to 320 MHz
2323 *
2324 * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized
2325 * correctly, the values must be sorted.
2326 */
2327 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth {
2328 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0,
2329 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40,
2330 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80,
2331 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160,
2332 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320,
2333 };
2334
2335 /**
2336 * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table
2337 *
2338 * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update
2339 * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default.
2340 * Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control.
2341 */
2342 struct ieee80211_sta_rates {
2343 struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2344 struct {
2345 s8 idx;
2346 u8 count;
2347 u8 count_cts;
2348 u8 count_rts;
2349 u16 flags;
2350 } rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE];
2351 };
2352
2353 /**
2354 * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
2355 *
2356 * Used to configure txpower for station.
2357 *
2358 * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames
2359 * to the STA.
2360 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
2361 * will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
2362 * %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
2363 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
2364 * per peer TPC.
2365 */
2366 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr {
2367 s16 power;
2368 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
2369 };
2370
2371 /**
2372 * struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates - info that is aggregated from active links
2373 *
2374 * Used for any per-link data that needs to be aggregated and updated in the
2375 * main &struct ieee80211_sta when updated or the active links change.
2376 *
2377 * @max_amsdu_len: indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes.
2378 * This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble.
2379 * For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply:
2380 *
2381 * * If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the
2382 * A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes.
2383 * * If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal
2384 * size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes.
2385 *
2386 * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level
2387 * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section
2388 * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2).
2389 * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control.
2390 * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID
2391 */
2392 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates {
2393 u16 max_amsdu_len;
2394
2395 u16 max_rc_amsdu_len;
2396 u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS];
2397 };
2398
2399 /**
2400 * struct ieee80211_link_sta - station Link specific info
2401 * All link specific info for a STA link for a non MLD STA(single)
2402 * or a MLD STA(multiple entries) are stored here.
2403 *
2404 * @sta: reference to owning STA
2405 * @addr: MAC address of the Link STA. For non-MLO STA this is same as the addr
2406 * in ieee80211_sta. For MLO Link STA this addr can be same or different
2407 * from addr in ieee80211_sta (representing MLD STA addr)
2408 * @link_id: the link ID for this link STA (0 for deflink)
2409 * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic)
2410 * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates
2411 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2412 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2413 * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA
2414 * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities
2415 * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities of this STA
2416 * @agg: per-link data for multi-link aggregation
2417 * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with
2418 * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the
2419 * station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode
2420 * notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after
2421 * the station moves to associated state.
2422 * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration
2423 *
2424 */
2425 struct ieee80211_link_sta {
2426 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2427
2428 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2429 u8 link_id;
2430 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
2431
2432 u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2433 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
2434 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
2435 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
2436 struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
2437 struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
2438
2439 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates agg;
2440
2441 u8 rx_nss;
2442 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth;
2443 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr;
2444 };
2445
2446 /**
2447 * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry
2448 *
2449 * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly
2450 * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in
2451 * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must
2452 * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly,
2453 * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a
2454 * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it.
2455 * This also represents the MLD STA in case of MLO association
2456 * and holds pointers to various link STA's
2457 *
2458 * @addr: MAC address
2459 * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP
2460 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU
2461 * that this station is allowed to transmit to us.
2462 * Can be modified by driver.
2463 * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does,
2464 * otherwise always false)
2465 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2466 * sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information.
2467 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid
2468 * if wme is supported. The bits order is like in
2469 * IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*.
2470 * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported.
2471 * @rates: rate control selection table
2472 * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer
2473 * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only
2474 * valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place.
2475 * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not.
2476 * @mlo: indicates whether the STA is MLO station.
2477 * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single
2478 * A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means
2479 * unlimited.
2480 * @cur: currently valid data as aggregated from the active links
2481 * For non MLO STA it will point to the deflink data. For MLO STA
2482 * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates() must be called to update it.
2483 * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not.
2484 * @txq: per-TID data TX queues; note that the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)
2485 * is used for non-data frames
2486 * @deflink: This holds the default link STA information, for non MLO STA all link
2487 * specific STA information is accessed through @deflink or through
2488 * link[0] which points to address of @deflink. For MLO Link STA
2489 * the first added link STA will point to deflink.
2490 * @link: reference to Link Sta entries. For Non MLO STA, except 1st link,
2491 * i.e link[0] all links would be assigned to NULL by default and
2492 * would access link information via @deflink or link[0]. For MLO
2493 * STA, first link STA being added will point its link pointer to
2494 * @deflink address and remaining would be allocated and the address
2495 * would be assigned to link[link_id] where link_id is the id assigned
2496 * by the AP.
2497 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO
2498 * @spp_amsdu: indicates whether the STA uses SPP A-MSDU or not.
2499 */
2500 struct ieee80211_sta {
2501 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2502 u16 aid;
2503 u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2504 bool wme;
2505 u8 uapsd_queues;
2506 u8 max_sp;
2507 struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates;
2508 bool tdls;
2509 bool tdls_initiator;
2510 bool mfp;
2511 bool mlo;
2512 bool spp_amsdu;
2513 u8 max_amsdu_subframes;
2514
2515 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates *cur;
2516
2517 bool support_p2p_ps;
2518
2519 struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1];
2520
2521 u16 valid_links;
2522 struct ieee80211_link_sta deflink;
2523 struct ieee80211_link_sta __rcu *link[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2524
2525 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
2526
2527 /* must be last */
2528 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2529 };
2530
2531 #ifdef CONFIG_LOCKDEP
2532 bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
2533 #else
lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta * pubsta)2534 static inline bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta)
2535 {
2536 return true;
2537 }
2538 #endif
2539
2540 #define link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id) \
2541 rcu_dereference_protected((sta)->link[link_id], \
2542 lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2543
2544 #define link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id) \
2545 rcu_dereference_check((sta)->link[link_id], \
2546 lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2547
2548 #define for_each_sta_active_link(vif, sta, link_sta, link_id) \
2549 for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((sta)->link); link_id++) \
2550 if ((!(vif)->active_links || \
2551 (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) && \
2552 ((link_sta) = link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id)))
2553
2554 /**
2555 * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command
2556 *
2557 * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2558 * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition.
2559 *
2560 * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping
2561 * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up
2562 */
2563 enum sta_notify_cmd {
2564 STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE,
2565 };
2566
2567 /**
2568 * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data
2569 *
2570 * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and
2571 * it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU.
2572 */
2573 struct ieee80211_tx_control {
2574 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2575 };
2576
2577 /**
2578 * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue
2579 *
2580 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2581 * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue
2582 * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue),
2583 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled)
2584 * @ac: the AC for this queue
2585 * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size
2586 *
2587 * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling
2588 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue().
2589 */
2590 struct ieee80211_txq {
2591 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
2592 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2593 u8 tid;
2594 u8 ac;
2595
2596 /* must be last */
2597 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2598 };
2599
2600 /**
2601 * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags
2602 *
2603 * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to
2604 * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning
2605 * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting
2606 * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule,
2607 * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully.
2608 *
2609 * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL:
2610 * The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be
2611 * controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm
2612 * should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace
2613 * will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control
2614 * algorithm.
2615 * Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of
2616 * callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have
2617 * the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config
2618 * @use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot
2619 * timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for
2620 * CCK frames.
2621 *
2622 * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS:
2623 * Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include
2624 * the FCS at the end.
2625 *
2626 * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING:
2627 * Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames
2628 * for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others
2629 * rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used
2630 * to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and
2631 * multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that
2632 * the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc().
2633 *
2634 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC:
2635 * Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We
2636 * expect values between 0 and @max_signal.
2637 * If possible please provide dB or dBm instead.
2638 *
2639 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM:
2640 * Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from
2641 * one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized
2642 * between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set.
2643 *
2644 * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT:
2645 * Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h
2646 * Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC
2647 *
2648 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION:
2649 * Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation.
2650 *
2651 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS:
2652 * Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep).
2653 *
2654 * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK:
2655 * Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies
2656 * stack support for dynamic PS.
2657 *
2658 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS:
2659 * Hardware has support for dynamic PS.
2660 *
2661 * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE:
2662 * Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w).
2663 *
2664 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS:
2665 * Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to
2666 * the stack.
2667 *
2668 * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR:
2669 * The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including
2670 * periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss.
2671 *
2672 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC:
2673 * This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e.
2674 * dtim_period).
2675 *
2676 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports
2677 * per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If
2678 * the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not
2679 * to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still
2680 * possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag
2681 * only in that case.
2682 *
2683 * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device
2684 * autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When
2685 * this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected
2686 * stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames.
2687 * Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure
2688 * the PS mode of connected stations.
2689 *
2690 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session
2691 * setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in
2692 * software.
2693 *
2694 * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of
2695 * a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only
2696 * active interfaces.
2697 *
2698 * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to
2699 * be created. It is expected user-space will create vifs as
2700 * desired (and thus have them named as desired).
2701 *
2702 * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the
2703 * crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically
2704 * try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if
2705 * the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its
2706 * supported cipher suites.
2707 *
2708 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit,
2709 * this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration
2710 * for frames.
2711 *
2712 * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface
2713 * queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC)
2714 * for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue
2715 * control for more details.
2716 *
2717 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate
2718 * selection table provided by the rate control algorithm.
2719 *
2720 * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any
2721 * P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface
2722 * is supported.
2723 *
2724 * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames
2725 * only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon.
2726 *
2727 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates
2728 * and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not
2729 * using aggregation for such frames.)
2730 *
2731 * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA)
2732 * for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support
2733 * is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the
2734 * CSA frame.
2735 *
2736 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload
2737 * or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first.
2738 *
2739 * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands
2740 * in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band.
2741 *
2742 * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth
2743 * than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel.
2744 *
2745 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs
2746 * within A-MPDU.
2747 *
2748 * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status
2749 * for sent beacons.
2750 *
2751 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each
2752 * station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified
2753 * by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station
2754 * from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time.
2755 *
2756 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the
2757 * reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in
2758 * order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session
2759 * timeout.
2760 *
2761 * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX,
2762 * which implies using per-CPU station statistics.
2763 *
2764 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated
2765 * A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support.
2766 * When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must
2767 * limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting
2768 * max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta.
2769 *
2770 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list
2771 * skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU.
2772 *
2773 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event
2774 * by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such
2775 * drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver
2776 * is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout.
2777 *
2778 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself.
2779 * The stack will not do fragmentation.
2780 * The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well.
2781 *
2782 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on
2783 * TDLS links.
2784 *
2785 * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't
2786 * support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug.
2787 *
2788 * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of
2789 * course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with.
2790 *
2791 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT
2792 * extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if
2793 * the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW
2794 * but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver.
2795 * See also the documentation for that flag.
2796 *
2797 * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all
2798 * MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use
2799 * TXQs to start with.
2800 *
2801 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU
2802 * length in tx status information
2803 *
2804 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2805 *
2806 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2807 * only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set.
2808 *
2809 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only
2810 * aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx
2811 * A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID.
2812 *
2813 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports tx encapsulation
2814 * offload
2815 *
2816 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports rx decapsulation
2817 * offload
2818 *
2819 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP: Hardware supports concurrent rx
2820 * decapsulation offload and passing raw 802.11 frames for monitor iface.
2821 * If this is supported, the driver must pass both 802.3 frames for real
2822 * usage and 802.11 frames with %RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR set for monitor to
2823 * the stack.
2824 *
2825 * @IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION: HW/driver has support for BSS color
2826 * collision detection and doesn't need it in software.
2827 *
2828 * @IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX: Hardware/driver handles transmitting
2829 * multicast frames on all links, mac80211 should not do that.
2830 *
2831 * @IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING: HW requires disabling puncturing in EHT
2832 * and connecting with a lower bandwidth instead
2833 * @IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING_5GHZ: HW requires disabling puncturing in
2834 * EHT in 5 GHz and connecting with a lower bandwidth instead
2835 *
2836 * @IEEE80211_HW_HANDLES_QUIET_CSA: HW/driver handles quieting for CSA, so
2837 * no need to stop queues. This really should be set by a driver that
2838 * implements MLO, so operation can continue on other links when one
2839 * link is switching.
2840 *
2841 * @IEEE80211_HW_STRICT: strictly enforce certain things mandated by the spec
2842 * but otherwise ignored/worked around for interoperability. This is a
2843 * HW flag so drivers can opt in according to their own control, e.g. in
2844 * testing.
2845 *
2846 * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays
2847 */
2848 enum ieee80211_hw_flags {
2849 IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL,
2850 IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS,
2851 IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING,
2852 IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
2853 IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM,
2854 IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC,
2855 IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT,
2856 IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION,
2857 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS,
2858 IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK,
2859 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS,
2860 IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE,
2861 IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF,
2862 IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF,
2863 IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL,
2864 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT,
2865 IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS,
2866 IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR,
2867 IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL,
2868 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK,
2869 IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS,
2870 IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW,
2871 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE,
2872 IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF,
2873 IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY,
2874 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES,
2875 IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA,
2876 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS,
2877 IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS,
2878 IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW,
2879 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU,
2880 IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS,
2881 IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR,
2882 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER,
2883 IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS,
2884 IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU,
2885 IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST,
2886 IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK,
2887 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG,
2888 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA,
2889 IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP,
2890 IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ,
2891 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW,
2892 IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ,
2893 IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN,
2894 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID,
2895 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID,
2896 IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT,
2897 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD,
2898 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD,
2899 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP,
2900 IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION,
2901 IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX,
2902 IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING,
2903 IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING_5GHZ,
2904 IEEE80211_HW_HANDLES_QUIET_CSA,
2905 IEEE80211_HW_STRICT,
2906
2907 /* keep last, obviously */
2908 NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS
2909 };
2910
2911 /**
2912 * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state
2913 *
2914 * This structure contains the configuration and hardware
2915 * information for an 802.11 PHY.
2916 *
2917 * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this
2918 * 802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev
2919 * members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV()
2920 * and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported
2921 * bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here.
2922 *
2923 * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use.
2924 *
2925 * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use
2926 * along with this structure.
2927 *
2928 * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags.
2929 *
2930 * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb
2931 * for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.)
2932 *
2933 * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb.
2934 * Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs.
2935 *
2936 * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used
2937 * only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB
2938 *
2939 * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval
2940 * that HW supports
2941 *
2942 * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for
2943 * data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these
2944 * queues need to have configurable access parameters.
2945 *
2946 * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware.
2947 * If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be
2948 * set before calling ieee80211_register_hw().
2949 *
2950 * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2951 * within &struct ieee80211_vif.
2952 * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2953 * within &struct ieee80211_sta.
2954 * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2955 * within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf.
2956 * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2957 * within @struct ieee80211_txq.
2958 *
2959 * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw
2960 * can handle.
2961 * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages
2962 * the hw can report back.
2963 * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage
2964 *
2965 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of
2966 * sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver
2967 * aggregation.
2968 * This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the
2969 * number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering
2970 * it shouldn't be set.
2971 *
2972 * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an
2973 * aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll
2974 * advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if
2975 * the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N
2976 * with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012).
2977 * For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used.
2978 *
2979 * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum
2980 * of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list.
2981 *
2982 * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX
2983 * (if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set)
2984 *
2985 * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW
2986 * reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't
2987 * include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only
2988 * adding _BW is supported today.
2989 *
2990 * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports,
2991 * the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH.
2992 * Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values.
2993 *
2994 * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the
2995 * @units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp
2996 * field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status
2997 * device_timestamp.
2998 * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a
2999 * IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a
3000 * IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value.
3001 * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the
3002 * radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set.
3003 *
3004 * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created
3005 * from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211,
3006 * other features will be rejected during HW registration.
3007 *
3008 * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate
3009 * for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery-
3010 * enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap.
3011 * Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means
3012 * that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means
3013 * neither enabled.
3014 *
3015 * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may
3016 * deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA.
3017 * Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values.
3018 *
3019 * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the
3020 * device.
3021 *
3022 * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from
3023 * them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed,
3024 * unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers.
3025 *
3026 * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while
3027 * refilling deficit of each TXQ.
3028 *
3029 * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set.
3030 *
3031 * @tx_power_levels: a list of power levels supported by the wifi hardware.
3032 * The power levels can be specified either as integer or fractions.
3033 * The power level at idx 0 shall be the maximum positive power level.
3034 *
3035 * @max_txpwr_levels_idx: the maximum valid idx of 'tx_power_levels' list.
3036 */
3037 struct ieee80211_hw {
3038 struct ieee80211_conf conf;
3039 struct wiphy *wiphy;
3040 const char *rate_control_algorithm;
3041 void *priv;
3042 unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)];
3043 unsigned int extra_tx_headroom;
3044 unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom;
3045 int vif_data_size;
3046 int sta_data_size;
3047 int chanctx_data_size;
3048 int txq_data_size;
3049 u16 queues;
3050 u16 max_listen_interval;
3051 s8 max_signal;
3052 u8 max_rates;
3053 u8 max_report_rates;
3054 u8 max_rate_tries;
3055 u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
3056 u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes;
3057 u8 max_tx_fragments;
3058 u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue;
3059 u8 radiotap_mcs_details;
3060 u16 radiotap_vht_details;
3061 struct {
3062 int units_pos;
3063 s16 accuracy;
3064 } radiotap_timestamp;
3065 netdev_features_t netdev_features;
3066 u8 uapsd_queues;
3067 u8 uapsd_max_sp_len;
3068 u8 max_nan_de_entries;
3069 u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift;
3070 u8 weight_multiplier;
3071 u32 max_mtu;
3072 const s8 *tx_power_levels;
3073 u8 max_txpwr_levels_idx;
3074
3075 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
3076 };
3077
_ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)3078 static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3079 enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
3080 {
3081 return test_bit(flg, hw->flags);
3082 }
3083 #define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg) _ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
3084
_ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)3085 static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3086 enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
3087 {
3088 return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags);
3089 }
3090 #define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg) _ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
3091
3092 /**
3093 * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request
3094 *
3095 * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie)
3096 * @req: cfg80211 request.
3097 */
3098 struct ieee80211_scan_request {
3099 struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies;
3100
3101 /* Keep last */
3102 struct cfg80211_scan_request req;
3103 };
3104
3105 /**
3106 * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters
3107 *
3108 * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from
3109 * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request
3110 * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode
3111 * @status: channel-switch response status
3112 * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received
3113 * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
3114 * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
3115 * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template
3116 * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb
3117 */
3118 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params {
3119 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3120 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef;
3121 u8 action_code;
3122 u32 status;
3123 u32 timestamp;
3124 u16 switch_time;
3125 u16 switch_timeout;
3126 struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb;
3127 u32 ch_sw_tm_ie;
3128 };
3129
3130 /**
3131 * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy
3132 *
3133 * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query
3134 *
3135 * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective
3136 * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private
3137 * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should
3138 * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this
3139 * is already used internally by mac80211.
3140 *
3141 * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy.
3142 */
3143 struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy);
3144
3145 /**
3146 * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware
3147 *
3148 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for
3149 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
3150 */
SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct device * dev)3151 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev)
3152 {
3153 set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev);
3154 }
3155
3156 /**
3157 * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware
3158 *
3159 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for
3160 * @addr: the address to set
3161 */
SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const u8 * addr)3162 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr)
3163 {
3164 memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN);
3165 }
3166
3167 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c)3168 ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3169 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3170 {
3171 if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0))
3172 return NULL;
3173 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx];
3174 }
3175
3176 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c)3177 ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3178 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3179 {
3180 if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0)
3181 return NULL;
3182 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx];
3183 }
3184
3185 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c,int idx)3186 ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3187 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx)
3188 {
3189 if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0)
3190 return NULL;
3191 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx];
3192 }
3193
3194 /**
3195 * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb
3196 * @hw: the hardware
3197 * @skb: the skb
3198 *
3199 * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure
3200 * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported.
3201 */
3202 void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
3203
3204 /**
3205 * ieee80211_purge_tx_queue - purge TX skb queue
3206 * @hw: the hardware
3207 * @skbs: the skbs
3208 *
3209 * Free a set of transmit skbs. Use this function when device is going to stop
3210 * but some transmit skbs without TX status are still queued.
3211 * This function does not take the list lock and the caller must hold the
3212 * relevant locks to use it.
3213 */
3214 void ieee80211_purge_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3215 struct sk_buff_head *skbs);
3216
3217 /**
3218 * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration
3219 *
3220 * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware
3221 * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations.
3222 *
3223 * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given
3224 * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and
3225 * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL
3226 * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to
3227 * the station information for the peer for individual keys.
3228 * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when
3229 * VLANs are configured for an access point.
3230 *
3231 * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx
3232 * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf
3233 * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function.
3234 *
3235 * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if
3236 * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be
3237 * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the
3238 * hardware key index. You are free to use the full u8 range.
3239 *
3240 * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is
3241 * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if
3242 * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the
3243 * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software.
3244 *
3245 * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed.
3246 *
3247 * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key
3248 * for it has been uploaded to hardware. The stack will not make any
3249 * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather
3250 * based on the receive flags.
3251 *
3252 * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key
3253 * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key()
3254 * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate
3255 * keys.
3256 *
3257 * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption
3258 * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key
3259 * handler.
3260 * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key.
3261 * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The
3262 * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did
3263 * rekeying); it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is
3264 * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this
3265 * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16.
3266 *
3267 * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index
3268 * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required
3269 * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses).
3270 *
3271 * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag
3272 * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following
3273 * requirements:
3274 * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to mac80211
3275 once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been completed,
3276 2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued
3277 at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits),
3278 3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command
3279 encrypted with the new key when also needing
3280 @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV and
3281 4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted.
3282 Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver.
3283 */
3284
3285 /**
3286 * DOC: Powersave support
3287 *
3288 * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations.
3289 *
3290 * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself;
3291 * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware
3292 * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode
3293 * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status.
3294 * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary,
3295 * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required
3296 * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when
3297 * it finds traffic directed to it.
3298 *
3299 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in
3300 * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused
3301 * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking
3302 * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it
3303 * back to sleep at appropriate times.
3304 *
3305 * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the
3306 * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be
3307 * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame.
3308 *
3309 * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also
3310 * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported
3311 * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and
3312 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still
3313 * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle
3314 * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that
3315 * as best as it can; mac80211 is too slow to do that.
3316 *
3317 * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the
3318 * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a
3319 * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to
3320 * the next wakeup. It's a compromise of getting good enough latency when
3321 * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle
3322 * periods.
3323 *
3324 * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling
3325 * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS
3326 * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally,
3327 * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the
3328 * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support
3329 * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the
3330 * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value
3331 * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable
3332 * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS
3333 * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave.
3334 *
3335 * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling
3336 * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the
3337 * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS
3338 * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To
3339 * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames
3340 * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled.
3341 *
3342 * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with
3343 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK.
3344 */
3345
3346 /**
3347 * DOC: Beacon filter support
3348 *
3349 * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups
3350 * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that
3351 * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly
3352 * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the
3353 * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That
3354 * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information
3355 * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed.
3356 *
3357 * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER
3358 * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support
3359 * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When
3360 * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the
3361 * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss().
3362 *
3363 * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the
3364 * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call
3365 * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled
3366 * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future.
3367 *
3368 * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing
3369 * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211
3370 * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense
3371 * that we want to see changes in them. This will include
3372 *
3373 * - a list of information element IDs
3374 * - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element
3375 *
3376 * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the
3377 * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense
3378 * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device
3379 * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all
3380 * vendor information elements.
3381 *
3382 * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information
3383 * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon.
3384 *
3385 * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead. Just make sure nothing
3386 * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing
3387 * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and
3388 * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136,
3389 * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility
3390 * it could also include some currently unused IDs.
3391 *
3392 *
3393 * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the
3394 * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming
3395 * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of
3396 * the received data packets). This can consist of notifying the host when
3397 * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above
3398 * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be
3399 * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement
3400 * them as the roaming algorithm requires.
3401 *
3402 * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to
3403 * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the
3404 * signal strength threshold checking.
3405 */
3406
3407 /**
3408 * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save
3409 *
3410 * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve
3411 * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism
3412 * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009)
3413 * "11.2.3 SM power save".
3414 *
3415 * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames
3416 * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct
3417 * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the
3418 * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware
3419 * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by
3420 * hardware flags.
3421 *
3422 * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211
3423 * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS
3424 * turned off otherwise.
3425 *
3426 * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate
3427 * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config()
3428 * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to
3429 * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP.
3430 */
3431
3432 /**
3433 * DOC: Frame filtering
3434 *
3435 * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper
3436 * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when
3437 * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption,
3438 * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is
3439 * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible.
3440 *
3441 * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell
3442 * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be
3443 * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out.
3444 *
3445 * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast()
3446 * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list
3447 * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces.
3448 * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to
3449 * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the
3450 * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and
3451 * @total_flags with the new flag states.
3452 *
3453 * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will
3454 * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count
3455 * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted
3456 * or dropped.
3457 *
3458 * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared.
3459 * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_
3460 * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore
3461 * the flag, but not clear it.
3462 * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the
3463 * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type
3464 * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it).
3465 * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware
3466 * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes
3467 * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them,
3468 * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag.
3469 * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well.
3470 */
3471
3472 /**
3473 * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients
3474 *
3475 * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for
3476 * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD.
3477 * There currently is no support for sAPSD.
3478 *
3479 * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client
3480 * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time.
3481 * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but
3482 * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies
3483 * the driver code.
3484 *
3485 * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete
3486 * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set,
3487 * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for
3488 * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames.
3489 * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of
3490 * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't
3491 * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD.
3492 *
3493 * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the
3494 * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a
3495 * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is,
3496 * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is
3497 * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this
3498 * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to
3499 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will
3500 * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The
3501 * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its
3502 * @sta_notify callback.
3503 *
3504 * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up,
3505 * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period.
3506 * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and
3507 * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When
3508 * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211
3509 * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames
3510 * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit
3511 * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER
3512 * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only
3513 * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to
3514 * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have
3515 * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS.
3516 * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is
3517 * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer.
3518 *
3519 * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by
3520 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them.
3521 *
3522 * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi
3523 * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up
3524 * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being
3525 * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong
3526 * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be
3527 * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to
3528 * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can
3529 * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it
3530 * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames
3531 * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again
3532 * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked.
3533 *
3534 * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any
3535 * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is
3536 * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any
3537 * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up
3538 * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when
3539 * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service
3540 * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called
3541 * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are
3542 * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting
3543 * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames.
3544 * To help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if
3545 * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames
3546 * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the
3547 * buffers for those TIDs contain.
3548 *
3549 * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may
3550 * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must
3551 * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that
3552 * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid
3553 * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released
3554 * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp()
3555 * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway.
3556 *
3557 * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211
3558 * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags
3559 * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
3560 * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame.
3561 * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case.
3562 *
3563 * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data
3564 * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as
3565 * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame
3566 * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed.
3567 */
3568
3569 /**
3570 * DOC: HW queue control
3571 *
3572 * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static
3573 * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This
3574 * was problematic for a few reasons:
3575 * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames
3576 * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly
3577 * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames
3578 *
3579 * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all
3580 * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it
3581 * won't have the same problem with the software queues.
3582 *
3583 * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability
3584 * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do
3585 * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif
3586 * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will
3587 * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and
3588 * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors
3589 * the hardware queue.
3590 * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue
3591 * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.)
3592 *
3593 * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed; multiple virtual
3594 * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to
3595 * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a
3596 * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have
3597 * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios:
3598 *
3599 * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3
3600 * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7
3601 * after-DTIM queue for AP: 8
3602 * off-channel queue: 9
3603 *
3604 * It would then set up the hardware like this:
3605 * hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9
3606 *
3607 * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows:
3608 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0
3609 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1
3610 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2
3611 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3
3612 * vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3613 * and the second virtual interface with 4-7.
3614 *
3615 * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second
3616 * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC.
3617 *
3618 * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3619 * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the
3620 * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when
3621 * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode.
3622 */
3623
3624 /**
3625 * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags
3626 *
3627 * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be
3628 * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the
3629 * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested,
3630 * but this has negative impact on power consumption.
3631 *
3632 * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested
3633 * by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by
3634 * multicast address.
3635 *
3636 * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the
3637 * %RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them)
3638 *
3639 * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set
3640 * the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them
3641 *
3642 * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate
3643 * to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses
3644 * by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing
3645 * mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should
3646 * honour this flag if possible.
3647 *
3648 * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this
3649 * station
3650 *
3651 * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes
3652 *
3653 * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames
3654 *
3655 * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames
3656 *
3657 * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames
3658 */
3659 enum ieee80211_filter_flags {
3660 FIF_ALLMULTI = 1<<1,
3661 FIF_FCSFAIL = 1<<2,
3662 FIF_PLCPFAIL = 1<<3,
3663 FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC = 1<<4,
3664 FIF_CONTROL = 1<<5,
3665 FIF_OTHER_BSS = 1<<6,
3666 FIF_PSPOLL = 1<<7,
3667 FIF_PROBE_REQ = 1<<8,
3668 FIF_MCAST_ACTION = 1<<9,
3669 };
3670
3671 /**
3672 * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions
3673 *
3674 * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in
3675 * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed.
3676 *
3677 * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation
3678 * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by
3679 * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer
3680 * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away!
3681 *
3682 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation
3683 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation
3684 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either
3685 * call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or
3686 * call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status
3687 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after
3688 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special
3689 * status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE.
3690 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational
3691 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting
3692 * queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the
3693 * driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe().
3694 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets,
3695 * called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call
3696 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the
3697 * session is gone and removes the station.
3698 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped
3699 * but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and
3700 * now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers
3701 * should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called.
3702 */
3703 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action {
3704 IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START,
3705 IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP,
3706 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START,
3707 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT,
3708 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH,
3709 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT,
3710 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL,
3711 };
3712
3713 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1
3714 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2
3715
3716 /**
3717 * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters
3718 *
3719 * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
3720 * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session
3721 * @tid: tid of the BA session
3722 * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When
3723 * action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the
3724 * actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here.
3725 * @buf_size: reorder buffer size (number of subframes). Valid only when the
3726 * action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or
3727 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3728 * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU.
3729 * valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3730 * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to
3731 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START
3732 */
3733 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params {
3734 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action;
3735 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3736 u16 tid;
3737 u16 ssn;
3738 u16 buf_size;
3739 bool amsdu;
3740 u16 timeout;
3741 };
3742
3743 /**
3744 * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason
3745 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll
3746 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to
3747 * frame received on trigger-enabled AC
3748 */
3749 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type {
3750 IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL,
3751 IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD,
3752 };
3753
3754 /**
3755 * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed
3756 *
3757 * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit
3758 * to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station
3759 * information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40
3760 * flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes.
3761 * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed.
3762 * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer
3763 * changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about
3764 * the peer.
3765 * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed
3766 * by the peer
3767 */
3768 enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed {
3769 IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED = BIT(0),
3770 IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED = BIT(1),
3771 IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED = BIT(2),
3772 IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED = BIT(3),
3773 };
3774
3775 /**
3776 * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type
3777 *
3778 * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations,
3779 * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other
3780 * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa).
3781 * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC
3782 * operations compared to other operations/flows.
3783 *
3784 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC.
3785 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required
3786 * for sending management frames offchannel.
3787 */
3788 enum ieee80211_roc_type {
3789 IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0,
3790 IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX,
3791 };
3792
3793 /**
3794 * enum ieee80211_reconfig_type - reconfig type
3795 *
3796 * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what
3797 * reconfiguration type was completed.
3798 *
3799 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type
3800 * (also due to resume() callback returning 1)
3801 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless
3802 * of wowlan configuration)
3803 */
3804 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type {
3805 IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART,
3806 IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND,
3807 };
3808
3809 /**
3810 * struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info - prepare TX information
3811 * @duration: if non-zero, hint about the required duration,
3812 * only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
3813 * @subtype: frame subtype (auth, (re)assoc, deauth, disassoc)
3814 * @success: whether the frame exchange was successful, only
3815 * used with the mgd_complete_tx() method, and then only
3816 * valid for auth and (re)assoc.
3817 * @was_assoc: set if this call is due to deauth/disassoc
3818 * while just having been associated
3819 * @link_id: the link id on which the frame will be TX'ed.
3820 * 0 for a non-MLO connection.
3821 */
3822 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info {
3823 u16 duration;
3824 u16 subtype;
3825 u8 success:1, was_assoc:1;
3826 int link_id;
3827 };
3828
3829 /**
3830 * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver
3831 *
3832 * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may
3833 * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure
3834 * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame.
3835 *
3836 * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame.
3837 * skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header.
3838 * The low-level driver should send the frame out based on
3839 * configuration in the TX control data. This handler should,
3840 * preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately.
3841 * Must be atomic.
3842 *
3843 * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware
3844 * is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on
3845 * frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.)
3846 * Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace,
3847 * or zero.
3848 * When the device is started it should not have a MAC address
3849 * to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device
3850 * is added.
3851 * Must be implemented and can sleep.
3852 *
3853 * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware
3854 * is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least
3855 * it must turn off frame reception.)
3856 * May be called right after add_interface if that rejects
3857 * an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue
3858 * you should ensure to cancel it on this callback.
3859 * Must be implemented and can sleep.
3860 *
3861 * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and
3862 * stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then
3863 * ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is
3864 * configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and
3865 * reconfigured at resume time.
3866 * The driver may also impose special conditions under which it
3867 * wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only
3868 * supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it
3869 * must return 1 from this function.
3870 *
3871 * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is
3872 * now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully
3873 * functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is
3874 * to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211
3875 * will also go through the regular complete restart on resume.
3876 *
3877 * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is
3878 * modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is
3879 * supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only
3880 * in suspend().
3881 *
3882 * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is
3883 * enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start
3884 * and @stop must be implemented.
3885 * The driver should perform any initialization it needs before
3886 * the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the
3887 * interface is given in the conf parameter.
3888 * The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a
3889 * negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.)
3890 * Must be implemented and can sleep.
3891 *
3892 * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback
3893 * is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be
3894 * switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep.
3895 * Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be
3896 * found by the interface iteration callbacks.
3897 *
3898 * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down.
3899 * The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface
3900 * and no monitor interfaces are present.
3901 * When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware
3902 * must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets,
3903 * the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the
3904 * MAC address of the device going away.
3905 * Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep.
3906 *
3907 * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this
3908 * function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel.
3909 * This function should never fail but returns a negative error code
3910 * if it does. The callback can sleep.
3911 *
3912 * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS
3913 * parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low
3914 * level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters).
3915 * This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless
3916 * for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which
3917 * of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback
3918 * can sleep.
3919 * Note: this callback is called if @vif_cfg_changed or @link_info_changed
3920 * are not implemented.
3921 *
3922 * @vif_cfg_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to interface
3923 * (MLD) parameters from &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg that vary during the
3924 * lifetime of the interface (e.g. assoc status, IP addresses, etc.)
3925 * The @changed parameter indicates which value changed.
3926 * The callback can sleep.
3927 *
3928 * @link_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to link
3929 * parameters from &struct ieee80211_bss_conf that are related to an
3930 * individual link. e.g. legacy/HT/VHT/... rate information.
3931 * The @changed parameter indicates which value changed, and the @link_id
3932 * parameter indicates the link ID. Note that the @link_id will be 0 for
3933 * non-MLO connections.
3934 * The callback can sleep.
3935 *
3936 * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration.
3937 * This callback is optional, and its return value is passed
3938 * to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic.
3939 *
3940 * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter.
3941 * See the section "Frame filtering" for more information.
3942 * This callback must be implemented and can sleep.
3943 *
3944 * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter.
3945 * This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames
3946 * should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination
3947 * of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates
3948 * which flags are changed.
3949 * This callback can sleep.
3950 *
3951 * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit
3952 * must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic.
3953 *
3954 * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3955 * This callback is only called between add_interface and
3956 * remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface
3957 * is enabled.
3958 * Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added.
3959 * The callback can sleep.
3960 *
3961 * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3962 * This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers
3963 * which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY.
3964 * The callback must be atomic.
3965 *
3966 * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the
3967 * host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data
3968 * necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter.
3969 * After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify
3970 * userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify().
3971 *
3972 * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for
3973 * WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP
3974 * offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it.
3975 *
3976 * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start
3977 * the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel
3978 * configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's
3979 * registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure
3980 * that power save is disabled.
3981 * The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the
3982 * entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these
3983 * at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the
3984 * (extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable).
3985 * When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called;
3986 * note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to
3987 * any error unless this callback returned a negative error code.
3988 * This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1,
3989 * this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a
3990 * software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this
3991 * capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't
3992 * advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is.
3993 * The callback can sleep.
3994 *
3995 * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan.
3996 * The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible),
3997 * but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call
3998 * ieee80211_scan_completed().
3999 * This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new
4000 * scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended.
4001 * The callback can sleep.
4002 *
4003 * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at
4004 * specific intervals. The driver must call the
4005 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results.
4006 * This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called.
4007 *
4008 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan.
4009 * In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called.
4010 *
4011 * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan
4012 * is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification.
4013 * The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR,
4014 * the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it
4015 * can use this parameter. The callback can sleep.
4016 *
4017 * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a
4018 * software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need
4019 * this notification.
4020 * The callback can sleep.
4021 *
4022 * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics.
4023 * Returns zero if statistics are available.
4024 * The callback can sleep.
4025 *
4026 * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does
4027 * IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the
4028 * IV/PN for the given key from hardware.
4029 * The callback must be atomic.
4030 *
4031 * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this
4032 * if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the
4033 * stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG
4034 * should be set as well.
4035 * The callback can sleep.
4036 *
4037 * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it)
4038 * The callback can sleep.
4039 *
4040 * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station,
4041 * AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
4042 *
4043 * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated
4044 * station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback
4045 * returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected;
4046 * no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing
4047 * the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
4048 * This callback can sleep.
4049 *
4050 * @vif_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add a debugfs vif
4051 * directory with its files. This callback should be within a
4052 * CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
4053 *
4054 * @link_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4055 * when a link is added to a mac80211 vif. This callback should be within
4056 * a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
4057 * For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the default bss_conf
4058 * with the vif's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
4059 *
4060 * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4061 * when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback
4062 * should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
4063 * callback can sleep.
4064 *
4065 * @link_sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4066 * when a link is added to a mac80211 station. This callback
4067 * should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
4068 * callback can sleep.
4069 * For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the deflink with the
4070 * station's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
4071 *
4072 * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an
4073 * associated station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating
4074 * in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag
4075 * %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic.
4076 *
4077 * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx
4078 * power for the station.
4079 * This callback can sleep.
4080 *
4081 * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a
4082 * station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.)
4083 * This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove.
4084 * It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions
4085 * up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it
4086 * isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace
4087 * period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station.
4088 * See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
4089 * The callback can sleep.
4090 *
4091 * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU
4092 * synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station
4093 * pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear
4094 * the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse
4095 * in @sta_state.
4096 * The callback can sleep.
4097 *
4098 * @sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can be
4099 * used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits
4100 * from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected
4101 * in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver
4102 * uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since
4103 * otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly.
4104 * Must be atomic.
4105 * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This
4106 * is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses
4107 * the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic.
4108 *
4109 * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon
4110 * filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so
4111 * let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of
4112 * the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not
4113 * all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible.
4114 * Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
4115 * The callback can sleep.
4116 *
4117 * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max),
4118 * bursting) for a hardware TX queue.
4119 * Returns a negative error code on failure.
4120 * The callback can sleep.
4121 *
4122 * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently,
4123 * this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a
4124 * required function.
4125 * The callback can sleep.
4126 *
4127 * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware.
4128 * Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a
4129 * required function.
4130 * The callback can sleep.
4131 *
4132 * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the
4133 * firmware/hardware. Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between
4134 * calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up
4135 * as TSF delay. Is not a required function.
4136 * The callback can sleep.
4137 *
4138 * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize
4139 * with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This
4140 * function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of
4141 * TSF synchronization.
4142 * The callback can sleep.
4143 *
4144 * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us.
4145 * This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is
4146 * used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests.
4147 * Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon.
4148 * The callback can sleep.
4149 *
4150 * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information
4151 *
4152 * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also
4153 * need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration,
4154 * and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback.
4155 * The callback can sleep.
4156 *
4157 * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified
4158 * in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout
4159 * accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout
4160 * estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for
4161 * coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep.
4162 *
4163 * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may
4164 * be %NULL. The callback can sleep.
4165 * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep.
4166 *
4167 * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure
4168 * that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap
4169 * of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces
4170 * use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues.
4171 * If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped.
4172 * Note that vif can be NULL.
4173 * The callback can sleep.
4174 *
4175 * @flush_sta: Flush or drop all pending frames from the hardware queue(s) for
4176 * the given station, as it's about to be removed.
4177 * The callback can sleep.
4178 *
4179 * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel
4180 * switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this
4181 * callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate
4182 * completion of the channel switch.
4183 *
4184 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
4185 * Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
4186 * reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
4187 * (also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
4188 *
4189 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
4190 *
4191 * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must
4192 * call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note
4193 * that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw
4194 * offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted
4195 * normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the
4196 * duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call
4197 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired().
4198 * Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and
4199 * must be accepted in this case.
4200 * This callback may sleep.
4201 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is
4202 * aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep.
4203 *
4204 * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes.
4205 *
4206 * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes.
4207 *
4208 * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware
4209 * queues before entering power save.
4210 *
4211 * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection
4212 * when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled.
4213 * The callback can sleep.
4214 * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See
4215 * &enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types.
4216 * The callback must be atomic.
4217 *
4218 * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given
4219 * parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for
4220 * sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver
4221 * to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD.
4222 * Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check
4223 * if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than
4224 * the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in
4225 * the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the
4226 * more-data bit must always be set.
4227 * The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames
4228 * from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set.
4229 * In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the
4230 * @num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In
4231 * this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4232 * on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll
4233 * period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple
4234 * responses for a retried PS-poll frame.
4235 * In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be
4236 * bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send
4237 * at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for
4238 * setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the
4239 * service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP
4240 * on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function
4241 * ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP.
4242 * This callback must be atomic.
4243 * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames
4244 * to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211
4245 * via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames
4246 * released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set
4247 * and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case
4248 * frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder
4249 * them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4250 * on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP
4251 * bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the
4252 * ieee80211_sta_eosp() function.
4253 * The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the
4254 * frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set.
4255 * This callback must be atomic.
4256 *
4257 * @get_et_sset_count: Ethtool API to get string-set count.
4258 * Note that the wiphy mutex is not held for this callback since it's
4259 * expected to return a static value.
4260 *
4261 * @get_et_stats: Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats.
4262 *
4263 * @get_et_strings: Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats
4264 * and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets.
4265 * Note that the wiphy mutex is not held for this callback since it's
4266 * expected to return a static value.
4267 *
4268 * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association
4269 * before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is
4270 * bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated
4271 * yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any
4272 * transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's
4273 * powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a
4274 * management frame prior to transmitting that frame to allow the driver
4275 * to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response and be
4276 * able to synchronize with the GO.
4277 * The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return
4278 * mac80211 will transmit the frame right away.
4279 * Additional information is passed in the &struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info
4280 * data. If duration there is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the
4281 * driver the duration for which the operation is requested.
4282 * The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep.
4283 * @mgd_complete_tx: Notify the driver that the response frame for a previously
4284 * transmitted frame announced with @mgd_prepare_tx was received, the data
4285 * is filled similarly to @mgd_prepare_tx though the duration is not used.
4286 * Note that this isn't always called for each mgd_prepare_tx() call, for
4287 * example for SAE the 'confirm' messages can be on the air in any order.
4288 *
4289 * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending
4290 * a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's
4291 * channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS
4292 * setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP.
4293 * mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS
4294 * discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least
4295 * 2 * (DTIM period).
4296 * The callback is optional and can sleep.
4297 *
4298 * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation.
4299 * This callback may sleep.
4300 * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction.
4301 * This callback may sleep.
4302 * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that
4303 * may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same
4304 * channel context with different settings
4305 * This callback may sleep.
4306 * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound
4307 * to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping.
4308 * This callback may sleep.
4309 * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being
4310 * unbound from vif.
4311 * This callback may sleep.
4312 * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to
4313 * another, as specified in the list of
4314 * @ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according
4315 * to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode.
4316 * This callback may sleep.
4317 *
4318 * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the
4319 * information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel
4320 * context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses
4321 * software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is
4322 * just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being
4323 * disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed.
4324 * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface.
4325 *
4326 * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and
4327 * during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed.
4328 * This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and
4329 * indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames).
4330 * This callback may sleep.
4331 *
4332 * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed.
4333 * Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces.
4334 * This callback is optional; it must not sleep.
4335 *
4336 * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel.
4337 * Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this
4338 * function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be
4339 * decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call
4340 * ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get()
4341 * get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is
4342 * 1 using ieee80211_beacon_counter_is_complete() after the beacon has been
4343 * transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish().
4344 * If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called,
4345 * since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway.
4346 * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4347 * before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA
4348 * gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing
4349 * the driver to prepare for the channel switch.
4350 * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4351 * after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the
4352 * driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4353 * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4354 * when channel switch procedure was aborted, allowing the
4355 * driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4356 * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called
4357 * when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with
4358 * CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count.
4359 * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all
4360 * information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A
4361 * channel context is bound before this is called.
4362 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again.
4363 *
4364 * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the
4365 * specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0
4366 * if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide.
4367 *
4368 * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration
4369 * and hardware limits.
4370 *
4371 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4372 * is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4373 * and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The
4374 * driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of
4375 * the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation.
4376 * The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can
4377 * optionally copy the skb for further re-use.
4378 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4379 * peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4380 * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or
4381 * response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets
4382 * parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue
4383 * an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch
4384 * response template is provided, together with the location of the
4385 * switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within
4386 * the function call.
4387 *
4388 * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue.
4389 * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a
4390 * synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues
4391 * pending frames that were received prior to the control path action
4392 * currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet.
4393 *
4394 * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one.
4395 * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster.
4396 * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf
4397 * contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters
4398 * are changed with respect to the last NAN config.
4399 * The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since
4400 * some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the
4401 * changed parameters.
4402 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in
4403 * cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of
4404 * this call.
4405 * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call
4406 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with
4407 * NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal.
4408 * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports
4409 * aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation
4410 * between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while
4411 * skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU.
4412 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4413 * Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4414 *
4415 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep)
4416 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep)
4417 * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep.
4418 * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer.
4419 * This callback may sleep.
4420 * @update_vif_offload: Update virtual interface offload flags
4421 * This callback may sleep.
4422 * @sta_set_4addr: Called to notify the driver when a station starts/stops using
4423 * 4-address mode
4424 * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4425 * @sta_set_decap_offload: Called to notify the driver when a station is allowed
4426 * to use rx decapsulation offload
4427 * @add_twt_setup: Update hw with TWT agreement parameters received from the peer.
4428 * This callback allows the hw to check if requested parameters
4429 * are supported and if there is enough room for a new agreement.
4430 * The hw is expected to set agreement result in the req_type field of
4431 * twt structure.
4432 * @twt_teardown_request: Update the hw with TWT teardown request received
4433 * from the peer.
4434 * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4435 * radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4436 * or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4437 * Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4438 * switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4439 * radar channel.
4440 * The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4441 * disable background CAC/radar detection.
4442 * @net_fill_forward_path: Called from .ndo_fill_forward_path in order to
4443 * resolve a path for hardware flow offloading
4444 * @can_activate_links: Checks if a specific active_links bitmap is
4445 * supported by the driver.
4446 * @change_vif_links: Change the valid links on an interface, note that while
4447 * removing the old link information is still valid (link_conf pointer),
4448 * but may immediately disappear after the function returns. The old or
4449 * new links bitmaps may be 0 if going from/to a non-MLO situation.
4450 * The @old array contains pointers to the old bss_conf structures
4451 * that were already removed, in case they're needed.
4452 * Note that removal of link should always succeed, so the return value
4453 * will be ignored in a removal only case.
4454 * This callback can sleep.
4455 * @change_sta_links: Change the valid links of a station, similar to
4456 * @change_vif_links. This callback can sleep.
4457 * Note that a sta can also be inserted or removed with valid links,
4458 * i.e. passed to @sta_add/@sta_state with sta->valid_links not zero.
4459 * In fact, cannot change from having valid_links and not having them.
4460 * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames. This is
4461 * not restored at HW reset by mac80211 so drivers need to take care of
4462 * that.
4463 * @net_setup_tc: Called from .ndo_setup_tc in order to prepare hardware
4464 * flow offloading for flows originating from the vif.
4465 * Note that the driver must not assume that the vif driver_data is valid
4466 * at this point, since the callback can be called during netdev teardown.
4467 * @can_neg_ttlm: for managed interface, requests the driver to determine
4468 * if the requested TID-To-Link mapping can be accepted or not.
4469 * If it's not accepted the driver may suggest a preferred mapping and
4470 * modify @ttlm parameter with the suggested TID-to-Link mapping.
4471 */
4472 struct ieee80211_ops {
4473 void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4474 struct ieee80211_tx_control *control,
4475 struct sk_buff *skb);
4476 int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4477 void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool suspend);
4478 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
4479 int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan);
4480 int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4481 void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled);
4482 #endif
4483 int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4484 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4485 int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4486 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4487 enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p);
4488 void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4489 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4490 int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 changed);
4491 void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4492 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4493 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4494 u64 changed);
4495 void (*vif_cfg_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4496 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4497 u64 changed);
4498 void (*link_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4499 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4500 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4501 u64 changed);
4502
4503 int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4504 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4505 void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4506 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4507
4508 u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4509 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list);
4510 void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4511 unsigned int changed_flags,
4512 unsigned int *total_flags,
4513 u64 multicast);
4514 void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4515 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4516 unsigned int filter_flags,
4517 unsigned int changed_flags);
4518 int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4519 bool set);
4520 int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd,
4521 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4522 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key);
4523 void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4524 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4525 struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf,
4526 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4527 u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key);
4528 void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4529 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4530 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4531 void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4532 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx);
4533 int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4534 struct ieee80211_scan_request *req);
4535 void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4536 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4537 int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4538 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4539 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req,
4540 struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies);
4541 int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4542 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4543 void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4544 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4545 const u8 *mac_addr);
4546 void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4547 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4548 int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4549 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats);
4550 void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4551 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
4552 struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
4553 int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4554 int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4555 int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4556 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4557 int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4558 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4559 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
4560 void (*vif_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4561 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4562 void (*link_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4563 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4564 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4565 struct dentry *dir);
4566 void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4567 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4568 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4569 struct dentry *dir);
4570 void (*link_sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4571 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4572 struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4573 struct dentry *dir);
4574 #endif
4575 void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4576 enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4577 int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4578 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4579 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4580 int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4581 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4582 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state,
4583 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state);
4584 void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4585 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4586 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4587 void (*sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4588 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4589 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4590 u32 changed);
4591 void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4592 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4593 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4594 void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4595 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4596 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4597 struct station_info *sinfo);
4598 int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4599 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4600 unsigned int link_id, u16 ac,
4601 const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params);
4602 u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4603 void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4604 u64 tsf);
4605 void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4606 s64 offset);
4607 void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4608 int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4609
4610 /**
4611 * @ampdu_action:
4612 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action.
4613 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want
4614 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through
4615 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
4616 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver
4617 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size
4618 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the
4619 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be
4620 * possible with a buf_size of 8:
4621 *
4622 * - ``TX: 1.....7``
4623 * - ``RX: 2....7`` (lost frame #1)
4624 * - ``TX: 8..1...``
4625 *
4626 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the
4627 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be:
4628 *
4629 * - ``TX: 1 or``
4630 * - ``TX: 18 or``
4631 * - ``TX: 81``
4632 *
4633 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again.
4634 *
4635 * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return
4636 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START
4637 * if the session can start immediately.
4638 *
4639 * The callback can sleep.
4640 */
4641 int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4642 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4643 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params);
4644 int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx,
4645 struct survey_info *survey);
4646 void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4647 void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, s16 coverage_class);
4648 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4649 int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4650 void *data, int len);
4651 int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
4652 struct netlink_callback *cb,
4653 void *data, int len);
4654 #endif
4655 void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4656 u32 queues, bool drop);
4657 void (*flush_sta)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4658 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4659 void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4660 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4661 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4662 int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4663 int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4664
4665 int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4666 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4667 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4668 int duration,
4669 enum ieee80211_roc_type type);
4670 int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4671 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4672 int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx);
4673 void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4674 u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max);
4675 bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4676 int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4677 const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4678 void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4679 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4680 const struct ieee80211_event *event);
4681
4682 void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4683 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4684 u16 tids, int num_frames,
4685 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4686 bool more_data);
4687 void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4688 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4689 u16 tids, int num_frames,
4690 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4691 bool more_data);
4692
4693 int (*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4694 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset);
4695 void (*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4696 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4697 struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data);
4698 void (*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4699 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4700 u32 sset, u8 *data);
4701
4702 void (*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4703 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4704 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4705 void (*mgd_complete_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4706 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4707 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4708
4709 void (*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4710 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4711 unsigned int link_id);
4712
4713 int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4714 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4715 void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4716 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4717 void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4718 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
4719 u32 changed);
4720 int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4721 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4722 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4723 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4724 void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4725 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4726 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4727 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4728 int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4729 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
4730 int n_vifs,
4731 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
4732
4733 void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4734 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type);
4735
4736 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6)
4737 void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4738 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4739 struct inet6_dev *idev);
4740 #endif
4741 void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4742 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4743 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4744 int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4745 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4746 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4747
4748 int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4749 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4750 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4751 void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4752 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4753 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4754 void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4755 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4756 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4757
4758 int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4759 void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4760 u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4761 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4762 int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4763 int *dbm);
4764
4765 int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4766 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4767 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class,
4768 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4769 struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie);
4770 void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4771 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4772 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4773 void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4774 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4775 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params);
4776
4777 void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4778 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
4779 void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4780
4781 int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4782 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4783 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4784 int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4785 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4786 int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4787 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4788 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes);
4789 int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4790 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4791 const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4792 void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4793 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4794 u8 instance_id);
4795 bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4796 struct sk_buff *head,
4797 struct sk_buff *skb);
4798 int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4799 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4800 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4801 int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4802 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4803 void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4804 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4805 int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4806 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4807 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4808 struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4809 int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4810 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4811 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids);
4812 void (*update_vif_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4813 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4814 void (*sta_set_4addr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4815 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4816 int (*set_sar_specs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4817 const struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4818 void (*sta_set_decap_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4819 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4820 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4821 void (*add_twt_setup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4822 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4823 struct ieee80211_twt_setup *twt);
4824 void (*twt_teardown_request)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4825 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 flowid);
4826 int (*set_radar_background)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4827 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4828 int (*net_fill_forward_path)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4829 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4830 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4831 struct net_device_path_ctx *ctx,
4832 struct net_device_path *path);
4833 bool (*can_activate_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4834 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4835 u16 active_links);
4836 int (*change_vif_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4837 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4838 u16 old_links, u16 new_links,
4839 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *old[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]);
4840 int (*change_sta_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4841 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4842 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4843 u16 old_links, u16 new_links);
4844 int (*set_hw_timestamp)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4845 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4846 struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts);
4847 int (*net_setup_tc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4848 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4849 struct net_device *dev,
4850 enum tc_setup_type type,
4851 void *type_data);
4852 enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res
4853 (*can_neg_ttlm)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4854 struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm *ttlm);
4855
4856 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
4857 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(2);
4858 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(3);
4859 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(4);
4860 };
4861
4862 /**
4863 * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device
4864 *
4865 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4866 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4867 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4868 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4869 * @priv_data_len.
4870 *
4871 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4872 * @ops: callbacks for this device
4873 * @requested_name: Requested name for this device.
4874 * NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d)
4875 *
4876 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4877 */
4878 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len,
4879 const struct ieee80211_ops *ops,
4880 const char *requested_name);
4881
4882 /**
4883 * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device
4884 *
4885 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4886 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4887 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4888 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4889 * @priv_data_len.
4890 *
4891 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4892 * @ops: callbacks for this device
4893 *
4894 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4895 */
4896 static inline
ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,const struct ieee80211_ops * ops)4897 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,
4898 const struct ieee80211_ops *ops)
4899 {
4900 return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL);
4901 }
4902
4903 /**
4904 * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device
4905 *
4906 * You must call this function before any other functions in
4907 * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you
4908 * need to fill the contained wiphy's information.
4909 *
4910 * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw()
4911 *
4912 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
4913 */
4914 int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4915
4916 /**
4917 * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description
4918 * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec
4919 * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds
4920 * (full cycle, ie. one off + one on period)
4921 */
4922 struct ieee80211_tpt_blink {
4923 int throughput;
4924 int blink_time;
4925 };
4926
4927 /**
4928 * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags
4929 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio
4930 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working
4931 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one
4932 * interface is connected in some way, including being an AP
4933 */
4934 enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags {
4935 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO = BIT(0),
4936 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK = BIT(1),
4937 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED = BIT(2),
4938 };
4939
4940 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4941 const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4942 const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4943 const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4944 const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4945 const char *
4946 __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4947 unsigned int flags,
4948 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4949 unsigned int blink_table_len);
4950 #endif
4951 /**
4952 * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED
4953 *
4954 * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4955 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4956 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4957 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4958 *
4959 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4960 *
4961 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4962 */
ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4963 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4964 {
4965 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4966 return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw);
4967 #else
4968 return NULL;
4969 #endif
4970 }
4971
4972 /**
4973 * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED
4974 *
4975 * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4976 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4977 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4978 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4979 *
4980 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4981 *
4982 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4983 */
ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4984 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4985 {
4986 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4987 return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw);
4988 #else
4989 return NULL;
4990 #endif
4991 }
4992
4993 /**
4994 * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED
4995 *
4996 * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4997 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4998 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4999 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
5000 *
5001 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
5002 *
5003 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
5004 */
ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)5005 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
5006 {
5007 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5008 return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw);
5009 #else
5010 return NULL;
5011 #endif
5012 }
5013
5014 /**
5015 * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED
5016 *
5017 * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware
5018 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
5019 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
5020 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
5021 *
5022 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
5023 *
5024 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
5025 */
ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)5026 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
5027 {
5028 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5029 return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw);
5030 #else
5031 return NULL;
5032 #endif
5033 }
5034
5035 /**
5036 * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger
5037 * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for
5038 * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags
5039 * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput
5040 * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table
5041 *
5042 * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are
5043 * configured) or the name of the new trigger.
5044 *
5045 * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw().
5046 */
5047 static inline const char *
ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,unsigned int flags,const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink * blink_table,unsigned int blink_table_len)5048 ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
5049 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
5050 unsigned int blink_table_len)
5051 {
5052 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5053 return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table,
5054 blink_table_len);
5055 #else
5056 return NULL;
5057 #endif
5058 }
5059
5060 /**
5061 * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device
5062 *
5063 * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources
5064 * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem.
5065 *
5066 * @hw: the hardware to unregister
5067 */
5068 void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5069
5070 /**
5071 * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor
5072 *
5073 * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the
5074 * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw()
5075 * before calling this function.
5076 *
5077 * @hw: the hardware to free
5078 */
5079 void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5080
5081 /**
5082 * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely
5083 *
5084 * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason
5085 * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state
5086 * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware
5087 * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by
5088 * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all
5089 * internal state that it has prior to calling this function.
5090 *
5091 * @hw: the hardware to restart
5092 */
5093 void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5094
5095 /**
5096 * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list
5097 *
5098 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5099 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5100 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5101 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5102 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5103 *
5104 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5105 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5106 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5107 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5108 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5109 *
5110 * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock
5111 *
5112 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5113 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
5114 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5115 * @list: the destination list
5116 */
5117 void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5118 struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list);
5119
5120 /**
5121 * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context
5122 *
5123 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5124 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5125 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5126 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5127 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5128 *
5129 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5130 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5131 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5132 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5133 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5134 *
5135 * This function must be called with BHs disabled.
5136 *
5137 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5138 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
5139 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5140 * @napi: the NAPI context
5141 */
5142 void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5143 struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi);
5144
5145 /**
5146 * ieee80211_rx - receive frame
5147 *
5148 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5149 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5150 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5151 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5152 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5153 *
5154 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5155 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5156 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5157 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5158 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5159 *
5160 * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni().
5161 *
5162 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5163 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5164 */
ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)5165 static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb)
5166 {
5167 ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL);
5168 }
5169
5170 /**
5171 * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame
5172 *
5173 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context
5174 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5175 *
5176 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not
5177 * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with
5178 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5179 *
5180 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5181 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5182 */
5183 void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
5184
5185 /**
5186 * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context)
5187 *
5188 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context
5189 * (internally disables bottom halves).
5190 *
5191 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may
5192 * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5193 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5194 *
5195 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5196 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5197 */
ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)5198 static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5199 struct sk_buff *skb)
5200 {
5201 local_bh_disable();
5202 ieee80211_rx(hw, skb);
5203 local_bh_enable();
5204 }
5205
5206 /**
5207 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta
5208 *
5209 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS
5210 * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station
5211 * entering/leaving PS mode.
5212 *
5213 * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled.
5214 *
5215 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against
5216 * each other.
5217 *
5218 * @sta: currently connected sta
5219 * @start: start or stop PS
5220 *
5221 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set.
5222 */
5223 int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start);
5224
5225 /**
5226 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta
5227 * (in process context)
5228 *
5229 * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context
5230 * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still
5231 * applies.
5232 *
5233 * @sta: currently connected sta
5234 * @start: start or stop PS
5235 *
5236 * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition().
5237 */
ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta * sta,bool start)5238 static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5239 bool start)
5240 {
5241 int ret;
5242
5243 local_bh_disable();
5244 ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start);
5245 local_bh_enable();
5246
5247 return ret;
5248 }
5249
5250 /**
5251 * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received
5252 * @sta: currently connected station
5253 *
5254 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5255 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a
5256 * connected station was received.
5257 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5258 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must
5259 * be serialized.
5260 */
5261 void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
5262
5263 /**
5264 * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received
5265 * @sta: currently connected station
5266 * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame
5267 *
5268 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5269 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame
5270 * from a connected station was received.
5271 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5272 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be
5273 * serialized.
5274 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown.
5275 * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC
5276 * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper
5277 * checks.
5278 */
5279 void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
5280
5281 /*
5282 * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions.
5283 * This is enough for the radiotap header.
5284 */
5285 #define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM ALIGN(14, 4)
5286
5287 /**
5288 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames
5289 * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station
5290 * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames
5291 * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID
5292 *
5293 * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing
5294 * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need
5295 * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit.
5296 *
5297 * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are
5298 * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data
5299 * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim
5300 * call! Beware of the locking!)
5301 *
5302 * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD)
5303 * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are
5304 * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes
5305 * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data,
5306 * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered
5307 * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP).
5308 *
5309 * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per
5310 * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since
5311 * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the
5312 * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that
5313 * use this API.
5314 */
5315 void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5316 u8 tid, bool buffered);
5317
5318 /**
5319 * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet
5320 *
5321 * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support
5322 * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent
5323 * rate selection table for the station entry.
5324 *
5325 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5326 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent.
5327 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
5328 * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information
5329 * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch
5330 */
5331 void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5332 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5333 struct sk_buff *skb,
5334 struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest,
5335 int max_rates);
5336
5337 /**
5338 * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback
5339 *
5340 * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta
5341 * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision
5342 * in updating the tx rate in data path.
5343 *
5344 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5345 * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for.
5346 * @info: tx status information
5347 */
5348 void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5349 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5350 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info);
5351
5352 /**
5353 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb - transmit status callback
5354 *
5355 * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been
5356 * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for
5357 * multicast frames but this can affect statistics.
5358 *
5359 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5360 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls
5361 * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe()
5362 * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5363 * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni().
5364 *
5365 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5366 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5367 */
5368 void ieee80211_tx_status_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5369 struct sk_buff *skb);
5370
5371 /**
5372 * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback
5373 *
5374 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status_skb()
5375 * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not
5376 * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info.
5377 *
5378 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5379 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5380 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5381 *
5382 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5383 * @status: tx status information
5384 */
5385 void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5386 struct ieee80211_tx_status *status);
5387
5388 /**
5389 * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb
5390 *
5391 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status_skb()
5392 * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to
5393 * specific skbs.
5394 *
5395 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5396 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5397 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5398 *
5399 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5400 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent
5401 * (NULL for multicast packets)
5402 * @info: tx status information
5403 */
ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_sta * sta,struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)5404 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5405 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5406 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
5407 {
5408 struct ieee80211_tx_status status = {
5409 .sta = sta,
5410 .info = info,
5411 };
5412
5413 ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status);
5414 }
5415
5416 /**
5417 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context)
5418 *
5419 * Like ieee80211_tx_status_skb() but can be called in process context.
5420 *
5421 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_skb() and
5422 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed
5423 * for a single hardware.
5424 *
5425 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5426 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5427 */
ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)5428 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5429 struct sk_buff *skb)
5430 {
5431 local_bh_disable();
5432 ieee80211_tx_status_skb(hw, skb);
5433 local_bh_enable();
5434 }
5435
5436 /**
5437 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback
5438 *
5439 * Like ieee80211_tx_status_skb() but can be called in IRQ context
5440 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5441 *
5442 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_skb() and
5443 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5444 *
5445 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5446 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5447 */
5448 void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5449 struct sk_buff *skb);
5450
5451 /**
5452 * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station
5453 *
5454 * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding
5455 * connected STA.
5456 *
5457 * @sta: the non-responding connected sta
5458 * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response
5459 */
5460 void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets);
5461
5462 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM 2
5463
5464 /**
5465 * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets
5466 * @tim_offset: position of TIM element
5467 * @tim_length: size of TIM element
5468 * @cntdwn_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM offsets
5469 * to countdown counters. This array can contain zero values which
5470 * should be ignored.
5471 * @mbssid_off: position of the multiple bssid element
5472 */
5473 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets {
5474 u16 tim_offset;
5475 u16 tim_length;
5476
5477 u16 cntdwn_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM];
5478 u16 mbssid_off;
5479 };
5480
5481 /**
5482 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function
5483 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5484 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5485 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5486 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5487 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5488 * that is not associated with AP MLD).
5489 *
5490 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5491 * obtain the beacon template.
5492 *
5493 * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the
5494 * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template
5495 * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when
5496 * applicable, the CSA count.
5497 *
5498 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5499 *
5500 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5501 */
5502 struct sk_buff *
5503 ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5504 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5505 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5506 unsigned int link_id);
5507
5508 /**
5509 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index - EMA beacon template generation
5510 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5511 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5512 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5513 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5514 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP).
5515 * @ema_index: index of the beacon in the EMA set.
5516 *
5517 * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5518 * but returns a beacon template which includes multiple BSSID element at the
5519 * requested index.
5520 *
5521 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL indicates the end of EMA templates.
5522 */
5523 struct sk_buff *
5524 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5525 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5526 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5527 unsigned int link_id, u8 ema_index);
5528
5529 /**
5530 * struct ieee80211_ema_beacons - List of EMA beacons
5531 * @cnt: count of EMA beacons.
5532 *
5533 * @bcn: array of EMA beacons.
5534 * @bcn.skb: the skb containing this specific beacon
5535 * @bcn.offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5536 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5537 */
5538 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons {
5539 u8 cnt;
5540 struct {
5541 struct sk_buff *skb;
5542 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets offs;
5543 } bcn[];
5544 };
5545
5546 /**
5547 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list - EMA beacon template generation
5548 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5549 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5550 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
5551 *
5552 * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5553 * but allocates and returns a pointer to list of all beacon templates required
5554 * to cover all profiles in the multiple BSSID set. Each template includes only
5555 * one multiple BSSID element.
5556 *
5557 * Driver must call ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list() to free the memory.
5558 *
5559 * Return: EMA beacon templates of type struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *.
5560 * %NULL on error.
5561 */
5562 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *
5563 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5564 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5565 unsigned int link_id);
5566
5567 /**
5568 * ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list - free an EMA beacon template list
5569 * @ema_beacons: list of EMA beacons of type &struct ieee80211_ema_beacons pointers.
5570 *
5571 * This function will free a list previously acquired by calling
5572 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list()
5573 */
5574 void ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list(struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *ema_beacons);
5575
5576 /**
5577 * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function
5578 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5579 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5580 * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset.
5581 * Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5582 * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length,
5583 * (including the ID and length bytes!).
5584 * Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5585 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5586 * that is not associated with AP MLD).
5587 *
5588 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5589 * obtain the beacon frame.
5590 *
5591 * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5592 * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon
5593 * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly
5594 * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt).
5595 *
5596 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5597 *
5598 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5599 */
5600 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5601 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5602 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length,
5603 unsigned int link_id);
5604
5605 /**
5606 * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function
5607 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5608 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5609 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5610 * that is not associated with AP MLD).
5611 *
5612 * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5613 *
5614 * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5615 */
ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_vif * vif,unsigned int link_id)5616 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5617 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5618 unsigned int link_id)
5619 {
5620 return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL, link_id);
5621 }
5622
5623 /**
5624 * ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn - request mac80211 to decrement the beacon countdown
5625 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5626 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5627 *
5628 * The beacon counter should be updated after each beacon transmission.
5629 * This function is called implicitly when
5630 * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the
5631 * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this
5632 * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's beacon countdown.
5633 *
5634 * Return: new countdown value
5635 */
5636 u8 ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5637 unsigned int link_id);
5638
5639 /**
5640 * ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn - request mac80211 to set beacon countdown
5641 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5642 * @counter: the new value for the counter
5643 *
5644 * The beacon countdown can be changed by the device, this API should be
5645 * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211.
5646 *
5647 * It should never be used together with ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(),
5648 * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value.
5649 */
5650 void ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter);
5651
5652 /**
5653 * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch
5654 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5655 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5656 *
5657 * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5658 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5659 * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed.
5660 */
5661 void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id);
5662
5663 /**
5664 * ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete - find out if countdown reached 1
5665 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5666 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5667 *
5668 * Return: %true if the countdown reached 1, %false otherwise
5669 */
5670 bool ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5671 unsigned int link_id);
5672
5673 /**
5674 * ieee80211_color_change_finish - notify mac80211 about color change
5675 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5676 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5677 *
5678 * After a color change announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5679 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5680 * notify mac80211 that the color can be changed
5681 */
5682 void ieee80211_color_change_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 link_id);
5683
5684 /**
5685 * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template
5686 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5687 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5688 *
5689 * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5690 * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller.
5691 *
5692 * Can only be called in AP mode.
5693 *
5694 * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error.
5695 */
5696 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5697 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5698
5699 /**
5700 * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template
5701 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5702 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5703 *
5704 * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to
5705 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5706 * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used.
5707 *
5708 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5709 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit.
5710 *
5711 * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error.
5712 */
5713 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5714 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5715
5716 /**
5717 * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template
5718 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5719 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5720 * @link_id: If the vif is an MLD, get a frame with the link addresses
5721 * for the given link ID. For a link_id < 0 you get a frame with
5722 * MLD addresses, however useful that might be.
5723 * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set
5724 * if at all possible
5725 *
5726 * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to
5727 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5728 * BSSID and address is used.
5729 *
5730 * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the
5731 * returned packet will be QoS NDP.
5732 *
5733 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5734 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields.
5735 *
5736 * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error.
5737 */
5738 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5739 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5740 int link_id, bool qos_ok);
5741
5742 /**
5743 * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
5744 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5745 * @src_addr: source MAC address
5746 * @ssid: SSID buffer
5747 * @ssid_len: length of SSID
5748 * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs
5749 *
5750 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5751 * hardware.
5752 *
5753 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
5754 */
5755 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5756 const u8 *src_addr,
5757 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
5758 size_t tailroom);
5759
5760 /**
5761 * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function
5762 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5763 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5764 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5765 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5766 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5767 * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame.
5768 *
5769 * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5770 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5771 * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5772 * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed.
5773 */
5774 void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5775 const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5776 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5777 struct ieee80211_rts *rts);
5778
5779 /**
5780 * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame
5781 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5782 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5783 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5784 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5785 *
5786 * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5787 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5788 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5789 *
5790 * Return: The duration.
5791 */
5792 __le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5793 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len,
5794 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5795
5796 /**
5797 * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function
5798 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5799 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5800 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5801 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5802 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5803 * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame.
5804 *
5805 * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5806 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5807 * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5808 * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed.
5809 */
5810 void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5811 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5812 const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5813 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5814 struct ieee80211_cts *cts);
5815
5816 /**
5817 * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame
5818 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5819 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5820 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5821 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5822 *
5823 * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5824 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5825 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5826 *
5827 * Return: The duration.
5828 */
5829 __le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5830 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5831 size_t frame_len,
5832 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5833
5834 /**
5835 * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame
5836 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5837 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5838 * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on
5839 * @frame_len: the length of the frame.
5840 * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted.
5841 *
5842 * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its
5843 * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps).
5844 *
5845 * Return: The duration.
5846 */
5847 __le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5848 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5849 enum nl80211_band band,
5850 size_t frame_len,
5851 struct ieee80211_rate *rate);
5852
5853 /**
5854 * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames
5855 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5856 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5857 *
5858 * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If
5859 * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast
5860 * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host
5861 * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered
5862 * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame.
5863 *
5864 * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered
5865 * frames are available.
5866 *
5867 * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was
5868 * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus
5869 * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns
5870 * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver
5871 * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to
5872 * use common code for all beacons.
5873 */
5874 struct sk_buff *
5875 ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5876
5877 /**
5878 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32
5879 *
5880 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32.
5881 *
5882 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5883 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5884 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5885 */
5886 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5887 u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5888
5889 /**
5890 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key
5891 *
5892 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken
5893 * from the given packet.
5894 *
5895 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5896 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted
5897 * with this P1K
5898 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5899 */
ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf * keyconf,struct sk_buff * skb,u16 * p1k)5900 static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5901 struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k)
5902 {
5903 struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data;
5904 const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control);
5905 u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]);
5906
5907 ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k);
5908 }
5909
5910 /**
5911 * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX
5912 *
5913 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32
5914 * and transmitter address.
5915 *
5916 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5917 * @ta: TA that will be used with the key
5918 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5919 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5920 */
5921 void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5922 const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5923
5924 /**
5925 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key
5926 *
5927 * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values
5928 * in the packet.
5929 *
5930 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5931 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be
5932 * encrypted with this key
5933 * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes
5934 */
5935 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5936 struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k);
5937
5938 /**
5939 * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos
5940 *
5941 * @pos: start of crypto header
5942 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5943 * @pn: PN to add
5944 *
5945 * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of
5946 * the packet payload)
5947 *
5948 * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should
5949 * point to the crypto header)
5950 */
5951 u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn);
5952
5953 /**
5954 * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter
5955 *
5956 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5957 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5958 * the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5959 * CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5960 * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
5961 *
5962 * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs
5963 * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done
5964 * by the device and not by mac80211.
5965 *
5966 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5967 * can be done concurrently.
5968 */
5969 void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5970 int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5971
5972 /**
5973 * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter
5974 *
5975 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5976 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5977 * the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5978 * CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5979 * @seq: new sequence data
5980 *
5981 * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the
5982 * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK
5983 * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called
5984 * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211.
5985 *
5986 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5987 * can be done concurrently.
5988 */
5989 void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5990 int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5991
5992 /**
5993 * ieee80211_remove_key - remove the given key
5994 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5995 *
5996 * Context: Must be called with the wiphy mutex held.
5997 *
5998 * Remove the given key. If the key was uploaded to the hardware at the
5999 * time this function is called, it is not deleted in the hardware but
6000 * instead assumed to have been removed already.
6001 */
6002 void ieee80211_remove_key(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
6003
6004 /**
6005 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN
6006 * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on
6007 * @keyconf: new key data
6008 * @link_id: the link id of the key or -1 for non-MLO
6009 *
6010 * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new
6011 * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper
6012 * RX processing, so this function allows setting them.
6013 *
6014 * Return: the newly allocated key structure, which will have
6015 * similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to
6016 * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an
6017 * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc.
6018 *
6019 * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware
6020 * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK
6021 * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver
6022 * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses
6023 * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part
6024 * of the reconfiguration.
6025 *
6026 * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq()
6027 * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly.
6028 *
6029 * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware,
6030 * then it will attempt to remove it during this call. In many cases
6031 * this isn't what you want, so call ieee80211_remove_key() first for
6032 * the key that's being replaced.
6033 */
6034 struct ieee80211_key_conf *
6035 ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6036 struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
6037 int link_id);
6038
6039 /**
6040 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying
6041 * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on
6042 * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association
6043 * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying
6044 * @gfp: allocation flags
6045 */
6046 void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid,
6047 const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
6048
6049 /**
6050 * ieee80211_key_mic_failure - increment MIC failure counter for the key
6051 *
6052 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
6053 * at the same time.
6054 *
6055 * @keyconf: the key in question
6056 */
6057 void ieee80211_key_mic_failure(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
6058
6059 /**
6060 * ieee80211_key_replay - increment replay counter for the key
6061 *
6062 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
6063 * at the same time.
6064 *
6065 * @keyconf: the key in question
6066 */
6067 void ieee80211_key_replay(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
6068
6069 /**
6070 * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue
6071 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6072 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6073 *
6074 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
6075 */
6076 void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6077
6078 /**
6079 * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue
6080 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6081 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6082 *
6083 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
6084 */
6085 void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6086
6087 /**
6088 * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue
6089 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6090 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6091 *
6092 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_queue_stopped.
6093 *
6094 * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise.
6095 */
6096
6097 int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6098
6099 /**
6100 * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues
6101 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6102 *
6103 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_stop_all_queues.
6104 */
6105 void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6106
6107 /**
6108 * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues
6109 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6110 *
6111 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_wake_all_queues.
6112 */
6113 void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6114
6115 /**
6116 * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan
6117 *
6118 * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is
6119 * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify
6120 * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from
6121 * any context, including hardirq context.
6122 *
6123 * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan
6124 * @info: information about the completed scan
6125 */
6126 void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6127 struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
6128
6129 /**
6130 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan
6131 *
6132 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the
6133 * driver whenever there are new scan results available.
6134 *
6135 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
6136 */
6137 void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6138
6139 /**
6140 * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped
6141 *
6142 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by
6143 * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task.
6144 * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan
6145 * while associating, for instance.
6146 *
6147 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
6148 */
6149 void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6150
6151 /**
6152 * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags
6153 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have
6154 * been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware
6155 * reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new
6156 * interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they
6157 * haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
6158 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all
6159 * interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
6160 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up).
6161 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER: Skip any interfaces where SDATA
6162 * is not in the driver. This may fix crashes during firmware recovery
6163 * for instance.
6164 */
6165 enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags {
6166 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL = 0,
6167 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL = BIT(0),
6168 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE = BIT(1),
6169 IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER = BIT(2),
6170 };
6171
6172 /**
6173 * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces
6174 *
6175 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6176 * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as
6177 * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep.
6178 * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6179 *
6180 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6181 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6182 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6183 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6184 */
6185 void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
6186 void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6187 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6188 void *data);
6189
6190 /**
6191 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces
6192 *
6193 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6194 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6195 * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
6196 * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can
6197 * be used.
6198 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6199 *
6200 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6201 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6202 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6203 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6204 */
6205 static inline void
ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,u32 iter_flags,void (* iterator)(void * data,u8 * mac,struct ieee80211_vif * vif),void * data)6206 ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
6207 void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6208 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6209 void *data)
6210 {
6211 ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw,
6212 iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE,
6213 iterator, data);
6214 }
6215
6216 /**
6217 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces
6218 *
6219 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6220 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6221 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6222 * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead.
6223 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6224 *
6225 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6226 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6227 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6228 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6229 */
6230 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6231 u32 iter_flags,
6232 void (*iterator)(void *data,
6233 u8 *mac,
6234 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6235 void *data);
6236
6237 /**
6238 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx - iterate active interfaces
6239 *
6240 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6241 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6242 * This version can only be used while holding the wiphy mutex.
6243 *
6244 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6245 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6246 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6247 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6248 */
6249 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6250 u32 iter_flags,
6251 void (*iterator)(void *data,
6252 u8 *mac,
6253 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6254 void *data);
6255
6256 /**
6257 * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations
6258 *
6259 * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
6260 * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
6261 * function for them.
6262 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6263 *
6264 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6265 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6266 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6267 */
6268 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6269 void (*iterator)(void *data,
6270 struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
6271 void *data);
6272
6273 /**
6274 * ieee80211_iterate_stations_mtx - iterate stations
6275 *
6276 * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
6277 * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
6278 * function for them. This version can only be used while holding the wiphy
6279 * mutex.
6280 *
6281 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6282 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6283 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6284 */
6285 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6286 void (*iterator)(void *data,
6287 struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
6288 void *data);
6289
6290 /**
6291 * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6292 *
6293 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue.
6294 * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be.
6295 *
6296 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6297 * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue
6298 */
6299 void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work);
6300
6301 /**
6302 * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6303 *
6304 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211
6305 * workqueue.
6306 *
6307 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6308 * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue
6309 * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
6310 */
6311 void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6312 struct delayed_work *dwork,
6313 unsigned long delay);
6314
6315 /**
6316 * ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer - Refresh a tx agg session timer.
6317 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6318 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6319 *
6320 * This function allows low level driver to refresh tx agg session timer
6321 * to maintain BA session, the session level will still be managed by the
6322 * mac80211.
6323 *
6324 * Note: must be called in an RCU critical section.
6325 */
6326 void ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6327 u16 tid);
6328
6329 /**
6330 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session.
6331 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6332 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6333 * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs)
6334 *
6335 * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise
6336 *
6337 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6338 * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6339 * will be managed by the mac80211.
6340 */
6341 int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid,
6342 u16 timeout);
6343
6344 /**
6345 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate.
6346 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6347 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6348 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6349 *
6350 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6351 * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called
6352 * from any context.
6353 */
6354 void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6355 u16 tid);
6356
6357 /**
6358 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session.
6359 * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop
6360 * @tid: the TID to stop BA.
6361 *
6362 * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active
6363 *
6364 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6365 * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6366 * will be managed by the mac80211.
6367 */
6368 int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid);
6369
6370 /**
6371 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate.
6372 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6373 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6374 * @tid: the desired TID to BA on.
6375 *
6376 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6377 * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It
6378 * can be called from any context.
6379 */
6380 void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6381 u16 tid);
6382
6383 /**
6384 * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station
6385 *
6386 * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on
6387 * @addr: station's address
6388 *
6389 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6390 *
6391 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6392 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6393 */
6394 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6395 const u8 *addr);
6396
6397 /**
6398 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware
6399 *
6400 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6401 * @addr: remote station's address
6402 * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'.
6403 *
6404 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6405 *
6406 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6407 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6408 *
6409 * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get
6410 * the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'.
6411 * We can have multiple STA associated with multiple
6412 * logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another
6413 * BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first).
6414 * In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL
6415 * is not reliable.
6416 *
6417 * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible.
6418 */
6419 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6420 const u8 *addr,
6421 const u8 *localaddr);
6422
6423 /**
6424 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs - find STA by link addresses
6425 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6426 * @addr: remote station's link address
6427 * @localaddr: local link address, use %NULL for any (but avoid that)
6428 * @link_id: pointer to obtain the link ID if the STA is found,
6429 * may be %NULL if the link ID is not needed
6430 *
6431 * Obtain the STA by link address, must use RCU protection.
6432 *
6433 * Return: pointer to STA if found, otherwise %NULL.
6434 */
6435 struct ieee80211_sta *
6436 ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6437 const u8 *addr,
6438 const u8 *localaddr,
6439 unsigned int *link_id);
6440
6441 /**
6442 * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up
6443 * @hw: the hardware
6444 * @pubsta: the station
6445 * @block: whether to block or unblock
6446 *
6447 * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues
6448 * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before
6449 * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be
6450 * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected
6451 * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag.
6452 *
6453 * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free
6454 * manner.
6455 *
6456 * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames
6457 * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not
6458 * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call
6459 * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to
6460 * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the
6461 * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must
6462 * call this function again to unblock the station. That will
6463 * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if
6464 * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also
6465 * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver
6466 * will be notified that the station woke up some time after
6467 * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually
6468 * woke up while blocked or not.
6469 */
6470 void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6471 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block);
6472
6473 /**
6474 * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP
6475 * @pubsta: the station
6476 *
6477 * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell
6478 * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the
6479 * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead.
6480 * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD.
6481 *
6482 * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must
6483 * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function
6484 * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or
6485 * all non-irqsafe, don't mix!
6486 *
6487 * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no
6488 * driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if
6489 * you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history
6490 * and restore the _irqsafe version!
6491 */
6492 void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6493
6494 /**
6495 * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP
6496 * @pubsta: the station
6497 * @tid: the tid of the NDP
6498 *
6499 * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close
6500 * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when
6501 * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window.
6502 * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a
6503 * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the
6504 * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to
6505 * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any
6506 * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong.
6507 * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame
6508 * will be sent despite the station being in power-save.
6509 * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames().
6510 * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver
6511 * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call
6512 * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent.
6513 */
6514 void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid);
6515
6516 /**
6517 * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates - recalculate aggregate data after a change
6518 * @pubsta: the station
6519 *
6520 * Call this function after changing a per-link aggregate data as referenced in
6521 * &struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates by accessing the agg field of
6522 * &struct ieee80211_link_sta.
6523 *
6524 * With non MLO the data in deflink will be referenced directly. In that case
6525 * there is no need to call this function.
6526 */
6527 void ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6528
6529 /**
6530 * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid
6531 *
6532 * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver must call
6533 * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of
6534 * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule
6535 * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness.
6536 *
6537 * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent
6538 * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not
6539 * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the
6540 * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame
6541 * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission
6542 * attempts.
6543 *
6544 * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or
6545 * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available.
6546 * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of
6547 * them to 0.
6548 *
6549 * @pubsta: the station
6550 * @tid: the TID to register airtime for
6551 * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec)
6552 * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec)
6553 */
6554 void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6555 u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime);
6556
6557 /**
6558 * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device
6559 *
6560 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6561 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6562 *
6563 * Return: %true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can
6564 * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return %false.
6565 */
6566 bool
6567 ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6568
6569 /**
6570 * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device
6571 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6572 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6573 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6574 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6575 *
6576 * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held; can sleep.
6577 *
6578 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6579 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6580 * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device
6581 * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend.
6582 *
6583 * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order
6584 * in which they were originally installed and handed to the
6585 * set_key callback.
6586 */
6587 void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6588 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6589 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6590 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6591 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6592 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6593 void *data),
6594 void *iter_data);
6595
6596 /**
6597 * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device
6598 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6599 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6600 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6601 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6602 *
6603 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6604 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6605 * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station
6606 * in removal process will be skipped.
6607 *
6608 * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section,
6609 * and thus iter must be atomic.
6610 */
6611 void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6612 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6613 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6614 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6615 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6616 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6617 void *data),
6618 void *iter_data);
6619
6620 /**
6621 * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts
6622 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6623 * @iter: iterator function
6624 * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
6625 *
6626 * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and
6627 * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other
6628 * places while calling into the driver.
6629 *
6630 * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
6631 * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
6632 * removed.
6633 *
6634 * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
6635 * before the restart are considered already present so will be
6636 * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
6637 * or not.
6638 */
6639 void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic(
6640 struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6641 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6642 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
6643 void *data),
6644 void *iter_data);
6645
6646 /**
6647 * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
6648 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6649 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6650 *
6651 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
6652 * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate
6653 * information. This function must only be called from within the
6654 * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function
6655 * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return
6656 * %NULL.
6657 *
6658 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
6659 */
6660 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6661 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6662
6663 /**
6664 * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons
6665 *
6666 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6667 *
6668 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and
6669 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the
6670 * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function.
6671 */
6672 void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6673
6674 /**
6675 * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP
6676 *
6677 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6678 *
6679 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and
6680 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver
6681 * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost.
6682 * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated
6683 * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set.
6684 *
6685 * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state,
6686 * without connection recovery attempts.
6687 */
6688 void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6689
6690 /**
6691 * ieee80211_disconnect - request disconnection
6692 *
6693 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6694 * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired
6695 *
6696 * Request disconnection from the current network and, if enabled, send a
6697 * hint to the higher layers that immediate reconnect is desired.
6698 */
6699 void ieee80211_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool reconnect);
6700
6701 /**
6702 * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume
6703 *
6704 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6705 *
6706 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume.
6707 * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the
6708 * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were
6709 * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or
6710 * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume.
6711 *
6712 * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses
6713 * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface
6714 * will still be added as associated first during resume and then
6715 * disconnect normally later.
6716 *
6717 * This function can only be called from the resume callback and
6718 * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it
6719 * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the
6720 * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto).
6721 */
6722 void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6723
6724 /**
6725 * ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect - disconnect from AP after
6726 * hardware restart
6727 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6728 *
6729 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after
6730 * hardware restart.
6731 */
6732 void ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6733
6734 /**
6735 * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring
6736 * rssi threshold triggered
6737 *
6738 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6739 * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type
6740 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
6741 * @gfp: context flags
6742 *
6743 * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality
6744 * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform
6745 * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold.
6746 */
6747 void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6748 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
6749 s32 rssi_level,
6750 gfp_t gfp);
6751
6752 /**
6753 * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss
6754 *
6755 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6756 * @gfp: context flags
6757 */
6758 void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp);
6759
6760 /**
6761 * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected
6762 *
6763 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6764 * @chanctx_conf: Channel context on which radar is detected. Mandatory to
6765 * pass a valid pointer during MLO. For non-MLO %NULL can be passed
6766 */
6767 void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6768 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf);
6769
6770 /**
6771 * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process
6772 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6773 * @success: make the channel switch successful or not
6774 * @link_id: the link_id on which the switch was done. Ignored if success is
6775 * false.
6776 *
6777 * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel
6778 * and wake up the suspended queues.
6779 */
6780 void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success,
6781 unsigned int link_id);
6782
6783 /**
6784 * ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect - disconnect due to channel switch error
6785 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6786 *
6787 * Instruct mac80211 to disconnect due to a channel switch error. The channel
6788 * switch can request to block the tx and so, we need to make sure we do not send
6789 * a deauth frame in this case.
6790 */
6791 void ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6792
6793 /**
6794 * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition
6795 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6796 * @link_id: link ID for MLO, or 0
6797 * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode
6798 *
6799 * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed
6800 * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than
6801 * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth.
6802 */
6803 void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6804 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode);
6805
6806 /**
6807 * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start
6808 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6809 */
6810 void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6811
6812 /**
6813 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
6814 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6815 */
6816 void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6817
6818 /**
6819 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions
6820 *
6821 * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device
6822 * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba
6823 * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs
6824 * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)."
6825 * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and
6826 * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation.
6827 *
6828 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6829 * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid
6830 * @addr: & to bssid mac address
6831 */
6832 void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap,
6833 const u8 *addr);
6834
6835 /**
6836 * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered
6837 * @pubsta: station struct
6838 * @tid: the session's TID
6839 * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are
6840 * assumed to be out of the window after the call
6841 * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc.
6842 * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware
6843 *
6844 * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and
6845 * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it
6846 * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released
6847 * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.)
6848 * (Only work correctly if @max_rx_aggregation_subframes <= 64 frames)
6849 */
6850 void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6851 u16 ssn, u64 filtered,
6852 u16 received_mpdus);
6853
6854 /**
6855 * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame
6856 *
6857 * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder
6858 * buffer.
6859 *
6860 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6861 * @ra: the peer's destination address
6862 * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session
6863 * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver
6864 */
6865 void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn);
6866
6867 /**
6868 * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work
6869 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6870 * @addr: station mac address
6871 * @tid: the rx tid
6872 */
6873 void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr,
6874 unsigned int tid);
6875
6876 /**
6877 * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session
6878 *
6879 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6880 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6881 * reordering.
6882 *
6883 * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6884 * when they complete AddBa negotiation.
6885 *
6886 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6887 * @addr: station mac address
6888 * @tid: the rx tid
6889 */
ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif * vif,const u8 * addr,u16 tid)6890 static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6891 const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6892 {
6893 if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6894 return;
6895 ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid);
6896 }
6897
6898 /**
6899 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session
6900 *
6901 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6902 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6903 * reordering.
6904 *
6905 * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6906 * when they complete DelBa negotiation.
6907 *
6908 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6909 * @addr: station mac address
6910 * @tid: the rx tid
6911 */
ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif * vif,const u8 * addr,u16 tid)6912 static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6913 const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6914 {
6915 if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6916 return;
6917 ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS);
6918 }
6919
6920 /**
6921 * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout
6922 *
6923 * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx
6924 * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer.
6925 *
6926 * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa.
6927 *
6928 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6929 * @addr: station mac address
6930 * @tid: the rx tid
6931 */
6932 void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6933 const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid);
6934
6935 /* Rate control API */
6936
6937 /**
6938 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo
6939 *
6940 * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for.
6941 * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on.
6942 * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration
6943 * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs
6944 * to be filled in
6945 * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate
6946 * which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and
6947 * used for rate calculations in the mesh network.
6948 * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the
6949 * RTS threshold
6950 * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission
6951 * if the selected rate supports it
6952 * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask
6953 * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use)
6954 * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode
6955 */
6956 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control {
6957 struct ieee80211_hw *hw;
6958 struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband;
6959 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf;
6960 struct sk_buff *skb;
6961 struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate;
6962 bool rts, short_preamble;
6963 u32 rate_idx_mask;
6964 u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask;
6965 bool bss;
6966 };
6967
6968 /**
6969 * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities
6970 */
6971 enum rate_control_capabilities {
6972 /**
6973 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW:
6974 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable)
6975 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains
6976 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has,
6977 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us.
6978 */
6979 RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0),
6980 /**
6981 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER:
6982 * mac80211 should start A-MPDU sessions on tx
6983 */
6984 RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER = BIT(1),
6985 };
6986
6987 struct rate_control_ops {
6988 unsigned long capa;
6989 const char *name;
6990 void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6991 void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv,
6992 struct dentry *debugfsdir);
6993 void (*free)(void *priv);
6994
6995 void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp);
6996 void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6997 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6998 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta);
6999 void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7000 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7001 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
7002 u32 changed);
7003 void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
7004 void *priv_sta);
7005
7006 void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv,
7007 struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7008 void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st);
7009 void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7010 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
7011 struct sk_buff *skb);
7012 void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
7013 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
7014
7015 void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta,
7016 struct dentry *dir);
7017
7018 u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta);
7019
7020 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
7021 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(2);
7022 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(3);
7023 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(4);
7024 };
7025
rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta * sta,enum nl80211_band band,int index)7026 static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
7027 enum nl80211_band band,
7028 int index)
7029 {
7030 return (sta == NULL || sta->deflink.supp_rates[band] & BIT(index));
7031 }
7032
7033 static inline s8
rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_sta * sta)7034 rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7035 struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
7036 {
7037 int i;
7038
7039 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
7040 if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
7041 return i;
7042
7043 /* warn when we cannot find a rate. */
7044 WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
7045
7046 /* and return 0 (the lowest index) */
7047 return 0;
7048 }
7049
7050 static inline
rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_sta * sta)7051 bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7052 struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
7053 {
7054 unsigned int i;
7055
7056 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
7057 if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
7058 return true;
7059 return false;
7060 }
7061
7062 /**
7063 * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver
7064 *
7065 * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass
7066 * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station
7067 * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on
7068 * the most recent rate control module decision.
7069 *
7070 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7071 * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination.
7072 * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station.
7073 *
7074 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
7075 */
7076 int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7077 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
7078 struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates);
7079
7080 int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
7081 void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
7082
7083 static inline bool
conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7084 conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7085 {
7086 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
7087 }
7088
7089 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7090 conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7091 {
7092 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
7093 conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
7094 }
7095
7096 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7097 conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7098 {
7099 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
7100 conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
7101 }
7102
7103 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7104 conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7105 {
7106 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40;
7107 }
7108
7109 static inline bool
conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7110 conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7111 {
7112 return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) &&
7113 (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) &&
7114 (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT);
7115 }
7116
7117 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type,bool p2p)7118 ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p)
7119 {
7120 if (p2p) {
7121 switch (type) {
7122 case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION:
7123 return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT;
7124 case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP:
7125 return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO;
7126 default:
7127 break;
7128 }
7129 }
7130 return type;
7131 }
7132
7133 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7134 ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7135 {
7136 return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p);
7137 }
7138
7139 /**
7140 * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif - return HE capabilities for sband/vif
7141 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
7142 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7143 *
7144 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or %NULL is none found
7145 */
7146 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7147 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7148 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7149 {
7150 return ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7151 }
7152
7153 /**
7154 * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
7155 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
7156 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7157 *
7158 * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
7159 */
7160 static inline __le16
ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7161 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7162 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7163 {
7164 return ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7165 }
7166
7167 /**
7168 * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif - return ETH capabilities for sband/vif
7169 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
7170 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7171 *
7172 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or %NULL is none found
7173 */
7174 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap *
ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7175 ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7176 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7177 {
7178 return ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7179 }
7180
7181 /**
7182 * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data
7183 *
7184 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
7185 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, otherwise 0
7186 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
7187 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
7188 *
7189 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and
7190 * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the
7191 * matching GroupId management frame.
7192 * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path.
7193 */
7194 void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
7195 const u8 *membership, const u8 *position);
7196
7197 void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7198 int rssi_min_thold,
7199 int rssi_max_thold);
7200
7201 void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7202
7203 /**
7204 * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface
7205 *
7206 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
7207 *
7208 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid.
7209 *
7210 * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not
7211 * applicable.
7212 */
7213 int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7214
7215 /**
7216 * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup
7217 * @vif: virtual interface
7218 * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s)
7219 * @gfp: allocation flags
7220 *
7221 * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup().
7222 */
7223 void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7224 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
7225 gfp_t gfp);
7226
7227 /**
7228 * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission
7229 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7230 * @vif: virtual interface
7231 * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver
7232 * @band: the band to transmit on
7233 * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to
7234 *
7235 * Return: %true if the skb was prepared, %false otherwise
7236 *
7237 * Note: must be called under RCU lock
7238 */
7239 bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7240 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb,
7241 int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta);
7242
7243 /**
7244 * ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap - Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header
7245 * of injected frames.
7246 *
7247 * To accurately parse and take into account rate and retransmission fields,
7248 * you must initialize the chandef field in the ieee80211_tx_info structure
7249 * of the skb before calling this function.
7250 *
7251 * @skb: packet injected by userspace
7252 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
7253 *
7254 * Return: %true if the radiotap header was parsed, %false otherwise
7255 */
7256 bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb,
7257 struct net_device *dev);
7258
7259 /**
7260 * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state
7261 *
7262 * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change
7263 * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending
7264 *
7265 * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent
7266 *
7267 * private:
7268 *
7269 * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors
7270 * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA
7271 */
7272 struct ieee80211_noa_data {
7273 u32 next_tsf;
7274 bool has_next_tsf;
7275
7276 u8 absent;
7277
7278 u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7279 struct {
7280 u32 start;
7281 u32 duration;
7282 u32 interval;
7283 } desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7284 };
7285
7286 /**
7287 * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE
7288 *
7289 * @attr: P2P NoA IE
7290 * @data: NoA tracking data
7291 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7292 *
7293 * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors
7294 */
7295 int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr,
7296 struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7297
7298 /**
7299 * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change
7300 *
7301 * @data: NoA tracking data
7302 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7303 */
7304 void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7305
7306 /**
7307 * ieee80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation
7308 * @vif: virtual interface
7309 * @peer: the peer's destination address
7310 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation
7311 * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown
7312 * @gfp: allocation flags
7313 *
7314 * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request().
7315 */
7316 void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer,
7317 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
7318 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
7319
7320 /**
7321 * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID
7322 *
7323 * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from
7324 * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such
7325 * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID,
7326 * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks
7327 * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be
7328 * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC.
7329 *
7330 * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it
7331 * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should
7332 * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7333 *
7334 * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for
7335 * @tid: the TID to reserve
7336 *
7337 * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure
7338 */
7339 int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7340
7341 /**
7342 * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID
7343 *
7344 * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function
7345 * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for
7346 * preventing use of this TID in the driver.
7347 *
7348 * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called
7349 * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called
7350 * from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7351 *
7352 * @sta: the station
7353 * @tid: the TID to unreserve
7354 */
7355 void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7356
7357 /**
7358 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7359 *
7360 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7361 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7362 * ieee80211_next_txq()
7363 *
7364 * Return: the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
7365 *
7366 * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section,
7367 * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in
7368 * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the
7369 * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call
7370 * but for the duration of the frame handling.
7371 * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method,
7372 * rcu_read_lock() is already held.
7373 *
7374 * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called.
7375 * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead.
7376 */
7377 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7378 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7379
7380 /**
7381 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7382 * (in process context)
7383 *
7384 * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context
7385 * (internally disables bottom halves).
7386 *
7387 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7388 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7389 * ieee80211_next_txq()
7390 *
7391 * Return: the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
7392 */
ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq)7393 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7394 struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7395 {
7396 struct sk_buff *skb;
7397
7398 local_bh_disable();
7399 skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq);
7400 local_bh_enable();
7401
7402 return skb;
7403 }
7404
7405 /**
7406 * ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue - mac80211 handler for wake_tx_queue callback
7407 *
7408 * @hw: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7409 * @txq: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7410 *
7411 * Drivers can use this function for the mandatory mac80211 wake_tx_queue
7412 * callback in struct ieee80211_ops. They should not call this function.
7413 */
7414 void ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7415 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7416
7417 /**
7418 * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from
7419 *
7420 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7421 * @ac: AC number to return packets from.
7422 *
7423 * Return: the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq
7424 * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the
7425 * driver has finished scheduling it.
7426 */
7427 struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7428
7429 /**
7430 * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs
7431 *
7432 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7433 * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for
7434 *
7435 * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq().
7436 * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently.
7437 */
7438 void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7439
7440 /* (deprecated) */
ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,u8 ac)7441 static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac)
7442 {
7443 }
7444
7445 void __ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7446 struct ieee80211_txq *txq, bool force);
7447
7448 /**
7449 * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission
7450 *
7451 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7452 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7453 *
7454 * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled,
7455 * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered.
7456 *
7457 * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for
7458 * this TXQ internally.
7459 */
7460 static inline void
ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq)7461 ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7462 {
7463 __ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, true);
7464 }
7465
7466 /**
7467 * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq()
7468 *
7469 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7470 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7471 * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets.
7472 *
7473 * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ
7474 * internally.
7475 */
7476 static inline void
ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq,bool force)7477 ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7478 bool force)
7479 {
7480 __ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, force);
7481 }
7482
7483 /**
7484 * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit
7485 *
7486 * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by
7487 * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime
7488 * fairness accounting without using the scheduling order enforced by
7489 * next_txq().
7490 *
7491 * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to
7492 * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have
7493 * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will
7494 * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit
7495 * again.
7496 *
7497 * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be
7498 * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates
7499 * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry
7500 * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this
7501 * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets
7502 * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq().
7503 *
7504 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7505 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7506 *
7507 * Return: %true if transmission is allowed, %false otherwise
7508 */
7509 bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7510 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7511
7512 /**
7513 * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq
7514 *
7515 * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e.
7516 * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up
7517 * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa.
7518 *
7519 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7520 * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count
7521 * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count
7522 */
7523 void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7524 unsigned long *frame_cnt,
7525 unsigned long *byte_cnt);
7526
7527 /**
7528 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
7529 *
7530 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination.
7531 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7532 *
7533 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7534 * @inst_id: the local instance id
7535 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
7536 * @gfp: allocation flags
7537 */
7538 void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7539 u8 inst_id,
7540 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
7541 gfp_t gfp);
7542
7543 /**
7544 * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event.
7545 *
7546 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The
7547 * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211.
7548 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7549 *
7550 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7551 * @match: match event information
7552 * @gfp: allocation flags
7553 */
7554 void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7555 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match,
7556 gfp_t gfp);
7557
7558 /**
7559 * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX.
7560 *
7561 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7562 * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length.
7563 *
7564 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7565 * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate
7566 * information.
7567 * @len: frame length in bytes
7568 *
7569 * Return: the airtime estimate
7570 */
7571 u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7572 struct ieee80211_rx_status *status,
7573 int len);
7574
7575 /**
7576 * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX.
7577 *
7578 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7579 * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length.
7580 *
7581 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7582 * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
7583 * @len: frame length in bytes
7584 *
7585 * Return: the airtime estimate
7586 */
7587 u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7588 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info,
7589 int len);
7590 /**
7591 * ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl - Get FILS discovery template.
7592 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7593 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7594 *
7595 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7596 *
7597 * Return: FILS discovery template. %NULL on error.
7598 */
7599 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7600 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7601
7602 /**
7603 * ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl - Get unsolicited broadcast
7604 * probe response template.
7605 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7606 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7607 *
7608 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7609 *
7610 * Return: Unsolicited broadcast probe response template. %NULL on error.
7611 */
7612 struct sk_buff *
7613 ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7614 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7615
7616 /**
7617 * ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify userland about a BSS color
7618 * collision.
7619 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
7620 *
7621 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7622 * @color_bitmap: a 64 bit bitmap representing the colors that the local BSS is
7623 * aware of.
7624 */
7625 void
7626 ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7627 u64 color_bitmap, u8 link_id);
7628
7629 /**
7630 * ieee80211_is_tx_data - check if frame is a data frame
7631 *
7632 * The function is used to check if a frame is a data frame. Frames with
7633 * hardware encapsulation enabled are data frames.
7634 *
7635 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
7636 *
7637 * Return: %true if @skb is a data frame, %false otherwise
7638 */
ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff * skb)7639 static inline bool ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff *skb)
7640 {
7641 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info = IEEE80211_SKB_CB(skb);
7642 struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (void *) skb->data;
7643
7644 return info->flags & IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP ||
7645 ieee80211_is_data(hdr->frame_control);
7646 }
7647
7648 /**
7649 * ieee80211_set_active_links - set active links in client mode
7650 * @vif: interface to set active links on
7651 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7652 *
7653 * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held; may sleep; calls
7654 * back into the driver.
7655 *
7656 * This changes the active links on an interface. The interface
7657 * must be in client mode (in AP mode, all links are always active),
7658 * and @active_links must be a subset of the vif's valid_links.
7659 *
7660 * If a link is switched off and another is switched on at the same
7661 * time (e.g. active_links going from 0x1 to 0x10) then you will get
7662 * a sequence of calls like
7663 *
7664 * - change_vif_links(0x11)
7665 * - unassign_vif_chanctx(link_id=0)
7666 * - change_sta_links(0x11) for each affected STA (the AP)
7667 * (TDLS connections on now inactive links should be torn down)
7668 * - remove group keys on the old link (link_id 0)
7669 * - add new group keys (GTK/IGTK/BIGTK) on the new link (link_id 4)
7670 * - change_sta_links(0x10) for each affected STA (the AP)
7671 * - assign_vif_chanctx(link_id=4)
7672 * - change_vif_links(0x10)
7673 *
7674 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
7675 */
7676 int ieee80211_set_active_links(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 active_links);
7677
7678 /**
7679 * ieee80211_set_active_links_async - asynchronously set active links
7680 * @vif: interface to set active links on
7681 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7682 *
7683 * See ieee80211_set_active_links() for more information, the only
7684 * difference here is that the link change is triggered async and
7685 * can be called in any context, but the link switch will only be
7686 * completed after it returns.
7687 */
7688 void ieee80211_set_active_links_async(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7689 u16 active_links);
7690
7691 /**
7692 * ieee80211_send_teardown_neg_ttlm - tear down a negotiated TTLM request
7693 * @vif: the interface on which the tear down request should be sent.
7694 *
7695 * This function can be used to tear down a previously accepted negotiated
7696 * TTLM request.
7697 */
7698 void ieee80211_send_teardown_neg_ttlm(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7699
7700 /* for older drivers - let's not document these ... */
7701 int ieee80211_emulate_add_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7702 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
7703 void ieee80211_emulate_remove_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7704 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
7705 void ieee80211_emulate_change_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7706 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
7707 u32 changed);
7708 int ieee80211_emulate_switch_vif_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7709 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
7710 int n_vifs,
7711 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
7712
7713 #endif /* MAC80211_H */
7714